elf.c revision 1.3 1 1.1 skrll /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2 1.1 skrll
3 1.1 skrll Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
4 1.3 christos 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
5 1.3 christos Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 1.1 skrll
7 1.1 skrll This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8 1.1 skrll
9 1.1 skrll This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 1.1 skrll it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 1.1 skrll the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 1.1 skrll (at your option) any later version.
13 1.1 skrll
14 1.1 skrll This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 1.1 skrll but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 1.1 skrll MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 1.1 skrll GNU General Public License for more details.
18 1.1 skrll
19 1.1 skrll You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 1.1 skrll along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
21 1.1 skrll Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
22 1.1 skrll MA 02110-1301, USA. */
23 1.1 skrll
24 1.1 skrll
25 1.1 skrll /*
26 1.1 skrll SECTION
27 1.1 skrll ELF backends
28 1.1 skrll
29 1.1 skrll BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
30 1.1 skrll Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
31 1.1 skrll (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
32 1.1 skrll
33 1.1 skrll Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
34 1.1 skrll to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
35 1.1 skrll haven't bothered yet. */
36 1.1 skrll
37 1.1 skrll /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
38 1.1 skrll #define _SYSCALL32
39 1.1 skrll #include "sysdep.h"
40 1.1 skrll #include "bfd.h"
41 1.1 skrll #include "bfdlink.h"
42 1.1 skrll #include "libbfd.h"
43 1.1 skrll #define ARCH_SIZE 0
44 1.1 skrll #include "elf-bfd.h"
45 1.1 skrll #include "libiberty.h"
46 1.1 skrll #include "safe-ctype.h"
47 1.1 skrll
48 1.3 christos #ifdef CORE_HEADER
49 1.3 christos #include CORE_HEADER
50 1.3 christos #endif
51 1.3 christos
52 1.1 skrll static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
54 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
55 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct bfd_strtab_hash **, int) ;
56 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
57 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset);
59 1.1 skrll
60 1.1 skrll /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 1.1 skrll currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 1.1 skrll need to move into elfcode.h. */
63 1.1 skrll
64 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
65 1.1 skrll
66 1.1 skrll void
67 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
70 1.1 skrll {
71 1.1 skrll dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 1.1 skrll dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 1.1 skrll dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 1.1 skrll dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 1.1 skrll dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 1.1 skrll dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 1.1 skrll dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
78 1.1 skrll }
79 1.1 skrll
80 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
81 1.1 skrll
82 1.1 skrll void
83 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
86 1.1 skrll {
87 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
94 1.1 skrll }
95 1.1 skrll
96 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
97 1.1 skrll
98 1.1 skrll void
99 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
102 1.1 skrll {
103 1.1 skrll dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 1.1 skrll dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
105 1.1 skrll }
106 1.1 skrll
107 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
108 1.1 skrll
109 1.1 skrll void
110 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
113 1.1 skrll {
114 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
116 1.1 skrll }
117 1.1 skrll
118 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
119 1.1 skrll
120 1.1 skrll void
121 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
124 1.1 skrll {
125 1.1 skrll dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 1.1 skrll dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 1.1 skrll dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 1.1 skrll dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 1.1 skrll dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
130 1.1 skrll }
131 1.1 skrll
132 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
133 1.1 skrll
134 1.1 skrll void
135 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
138 1.1 skrll {
139 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
144 1.1 skrll }
145 1.1 skrll
146 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
147 1.1 skrll
148 1.1 skrll void
149 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
152 1.1 skrll {
153 1.1 skrll dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 1.1 skrll dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 1.1 skrll dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 1.1 skrll dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 1.1 skrll dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
158 1.1 skrll }
159 1.1 skrll
160 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
161 1.1 skrll
162 1.1 skrll void
163 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
166 1.1 skrll {
167 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
172 1.1 skrll }
173 1.1 skrll
174 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
175 1.1 skrll
176 1.1 skrll void
177 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
180 1.1 skrll {
181 1.1 skrll dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
182 1.1 skrll }
183 1.1 skrll
184 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
185 1.1 skrll
186 1.1 skrll void
187 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Versym *dst)
190 1.1 skrll {
191 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
192 1.1 skrll }
193 1.1 skrll
194 1.1 skrll /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 1.1 skrll cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
196 1.1 skrll
197 1.1 skrll unsigned long
198 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
199 1.1 skrll {
200 1.1 skrll const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
201 1.1 skrll unsigned long h = 0;
202 1.1 skrll unsigned long g;
203 1.1 skrll int ch;
204 1.1 skrll
205 1.1 skrll while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
206 1.1 skrll {
207 1.1 skrll h = (h << 4) + ch;
208 1.1 skrll if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
209 1.1 skrll {
210 1.1 skrll h ^= g >> 24;
211 1.1 skrll /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 1.1 skrll this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
213 1.1 skrll h ^= g;
214 1.1 skrll }
215 1.1 skrll }
216 1.1 skrll return h & 0xffffffff;
217 1.1 skrll }
218 1.1 skrll
219 1.1 skrll /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 1.1 skrll cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
221 1.1 skrll
222 1.1 skrll unsigned long
223 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
224 1.1 skrll {
225 1.1 skrll const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 1.1 skrll unsigned long h = 5381;
227 1.1 skrll unsigned char ch;
228 1.1 skrll
229 1.1 skrll while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 1.1 skrll h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 1.1 skrll return h & 0xffffffff;
232 1.1 skrll }
233 1.1 skrll
234 1.1 skrll /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 1.1 skrll the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
236 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
237 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
238 1.1 skrll size_t object_size,
239 1.3 christos enum elf_target_id object_id)
240 1.1 skrll {
241 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 1.1 skrll abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 1.1 skrll if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
244 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
245 1.1 skrll
246 1.1 skrll elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 1.1 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
248 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
249 1.1 skrll }
250 1.1 skrll
251 1.1 skrll
252 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
253 1.3 christos bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
254 1.1 skrll {
255 1.3 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
256 1.1 skrll return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
257 1.3 christos bed->target_id);
258 1.1 skrll }
259 1.1 skrll
260 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
261 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
262 1.1 skrll {
263 1.1 skrll /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
264 1.3 christos return abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd);
265 1.1 skrll }
266 1.1 skrll
267 1.3 christos static char *
268 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
269 1.1 skrll {
270 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
271 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
272 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset;
273 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
274 1.1 skrll
275 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
276 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp == 0
277 1.1 skrll || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
278 1.1 skrll || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
279 1.1 skrll return NULL;
280 1.1 skrll
281 1.1 skrll shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
282 1.1 skrll if (shstrtab == NULL)
283 1.1 skrll {
284 1.1 skrll /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
285 1.1 skrll offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
286 1.1 skrll shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
287 1.1 skrll
288 1.1 skrll /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
289 1.1 skrll in case the string table is not terminated. */
290 1.1 skrll if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
291 1.3 christos || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL
292 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
293 1.1 skrll shstrtab = NULL;
294 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
295 1.1 skrll {
296 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
297 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
298 1.1 skrll shstrtab = NULL;
299 1.1 skrll /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
300 1.1 skrll trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
301 1.1 skrll the string table over and over. */
302 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
303 1.1 skrll }
304 1.1 skrll else
305 1.1 skrll shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
306 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
307 1.1 skrll }
308 1.1 skrll return (char *) shstrtab;
309 1.1 skrll }
310 1.1 skrll
311 1.1 skrll char *
312 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
313 1.1 skrll unsigned int shindex,
314 1.1 skrll unsigned int strindex)
315 1.1 skrll {
316 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
317 1.1 skrll
318 1.1 skrll if (strindex == 0)
319 1.1 skrll return "";
320 1.1 skrll
321 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
322 1.1 skrll return NULL;
323 1.1 skrll
324 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
325 1.1 skrll
326 1.1 skrll if (hdr->contents == NULL
327 1.1 skrll && bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
328 1.1 skrll return NULL;
329 1.1 skrll
330 1.1 skrll if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
331 1.1 skrll {
332 1.1 skrll unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
333 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
334 1.1 skrll (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
335 1.1 skrll abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
336 1.1 skrll (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
337 1.1 skrll ? ".shstrtab"
338 1.1 skrll : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
339 1.3 christos return NULL;
340 1.1 skrll }
341 1.1 skrll
342 1.1 skrll return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
343 1.1 skrll }
344 1.1 skrll
345 1.1 skrll /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
346 1.1 skrll SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
347 1.1 skrll symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
348 1.1 skrll are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
349 1.1 skrll symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
350 1.1 skrll Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
351 1.1 skrll or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
352 1.1 skrll
353 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *
354 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
355 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
356 1.1 skrll size_t symcount,
357 1.1 skrll size_t symoffset,
358 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
359 1.1 skrll void *extsym_buf,
360 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
361 1.1 skrll {
362 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
363 1.1 skrll void *alloc_ext;
364 1.1 skrll const bfd_byte *esym;
365 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
366 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
367 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
368 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
369 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
370 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
371 1.1 skrll size_t extsym_size;
372 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
373 1.1 skrll file_ptr pos;
374 1.1 skrll
375 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
376 1.1 skrll abort ();
377 1.1 skrll
378 1.1 skrll if (symcount == 0)
379 1.1 skrll return intsym_buf;
380 1.1 skrll
381 1.1 skrll /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
382 1.1 skrll shndx_hdr = NULL;
383 1.1 skrll if (symtab_hdr == &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_hdr)
384 1.1 skrll shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
385 1.1 skrll
386 1.1 skrll /* Read the symbols. */
387 1.1 skrll alloc_ext = NULL;
388 1.1 skrll alloc_extshndx = NULL;
389 1.1 skrll alloc_intsym = NULL;
390 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
391 1.1 skrll extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
392 1.1 skrll amt = symcount * extsym_size;
393 1.1 skrll pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
394 1.1 skrll if (extsym_buf == NULL)
395 1.1 skrll {
396 1.1 skrll alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
397 1.1 skrll extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
398 1.1 skrll }
399 1.1 skrll if (extsym_buf == NULL
400 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
401 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
402 1.1 skrll {
403 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
404 1.1 skrll goto out;
405 1.1 skrll }
406 1.1 skrll
407 1.1 skrll if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
408 1.1 skrll extshndx_buf = NULL;
409 1.1 skrll else
410 1.1 skrll {
411 1.1 skrll amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
412 1.1 skrll pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
413 1.1 skrll if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
414 1.1 skrll {
415 1.3 christos alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
416 1.3 christos bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
417 1.1 skrll extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
418 1.1 skrll }
419 1.1 skrll if (extshndx_buf == NULL
420 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
421 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
422 1.1 skrll {
423 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
424 1.1 skrll goto out;
425 1.1 skrll }
426 1.1 skrll }
427 1.1 skrll
428 1.1 skrll if (intsym_buf == NULL)
429 1.1 skrll {
430 1.3 christos alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
431 1.3 christos bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
432 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
433 1.1 skrll if (intsym_buf == NULL)
434 1.1 skrll goto out;
435 1.1 skrll }
436 1.1 skrll
437 1.1 skrll /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
438 1.1 skrll isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
439 1.3 christos for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
440 1.3 christos shndx = extshndx_buf;
441 1.1 skrll isym < isymend;
442 1.1 skrll esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
443 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
444 1.1 skrll {
445 1.1 skrll symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
446 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
447 1.1 skrll "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
448 1.1 skrll ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
449 1.1 skrll if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
450 1.1 skrll free (alloc_intsym);
451 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
452 1.1 skrll goto out;
453 1.1 skrll }
454 1.1 skrll
455 1.1 skrll out:
456 1.1 skrll if (alloc_ext != NULL)
457 1.1 skrll free (alloc_ext);
458 1.1 skrll if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
459 1.1 skrll free (alloc_extshndx);
460 1.1 skrll
461 1.1 skrll return intsym_buf;
462 1.1 skrll }
463 1.1 skrll
464 1.1 skrll /* Look up a symbol name. */
465 1.1 skrll const char *
466 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
467 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
468 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
469 1.1 skrll asection *sym_sec)
470 1.1 skrll {
471 1.1 skrll const char *name;
472 1.1 skrll unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
473 1.1 skrll unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
474 1.1 skrll
475 1.1 skrll if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
476 1.1 skrll /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
477 1.1 skrll && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
478 1.1 skrll {
479 1.1 skrll iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
480 1.1 skrll shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
481 1.1 skrll }
482 1.1 skrll
483 1.1 skrll name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
484 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
485 1.1 skrll name = "(null)";
486 1.1 skrll else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
487 1.1 skrll name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
488 1.1 skrll
489 1.1 skrll return name;
490 1.1 skrll }
491 1.1 skrll
492 1.1 skrll /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
493 1.1 skrll sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
494 1.1 skrll pointers. */
495 1.1 skrll
496 1.1 skrll typedef union elf_internal_group {
497 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
498 1.1 skrll unsigned int flags;
499 1.1 skrll } Elf_Internal_Group;
500 1.1 skrll
501 1.1 skrll /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
502 1.1 skrll signature just a string? */
503 1.1 skrll
504 1.1 skrll static const char *
505 1.1 skrll group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
506 1.1 skrll {
507 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
508 1.1 skrll unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
509 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
510 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
511 1.1 skrll
512 1.1 skrll /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
513 1.1 skrll that it is a symbol table section. */
514 1.1 skrll if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
515 1.1 skrll return NULL;
516 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
517 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
518 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
519 1.1 skrll return NULL;
520 1.1 skrll
521 1.1 skrll /* Go read the symbol. */
522 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
523 1.1 skrll if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
524 1.1 skrll &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
525 1.1 skrll return NULL;
526 1.1 skrll
527 1.1 skrll return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
528 1.1 skrll }
529 1.1 skrll
530 1.1 skrll /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
531 1.1 skrll
532 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
533 1.1 skrll setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
534 1.1 skrll {
535 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
536 1.1 skrll
537 1.1 skrll /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
538 1.1 skrll is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
539 1.1 skrll if (num_group == 0)
540 1.1 skrll {
541 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, shnum;
542 1.1 skrll
543 1.1 skrll /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
544 1.1 skrll section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
545 1.1 skrll shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
546 1.1 skrll num_group = 0;
547 1.1 skrll
548 1.1 skrll #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr) \
549 1.1 skrll ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
550 1.1 skrll && (shdr)->sh_size >= (2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) \
551 1.1 skrll && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
552 1.1 skrll && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
553 1.1 skrll
554 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
555 1.1 skrll {
556 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
557 1.1 skrll
558 1.1 skrll if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
559 1.1 skrll num_group += 1;
560 1.1 skrll }
561 1.1 skrll
562 1.1 skrll if (num_group == 0)
563 1.1 skrll {
564 1.1 skrll num_group = (unsigned) -1;
565 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
566 1.1 skrll }
567 1.1 skrll else
568 1.1 skrll {
569 1.1 skrll /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
570 1.1 skrll so we can find them quickly. */
571 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
572 1.1 skrll
573 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
574 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
575 1.3 christos bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
576 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
577 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
578 1.1 skrll
579 1.1 skrll num_group = 0;
580 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
581 1.1 skrll {
582 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
583 1.1 skrll
584 1.1 skrll if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
585 1.1 skrll {
586 1.1 skrll unsigned char *src;
587 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
588 1.1 skrll
589 1.1 skrll /* Add to list of sections. */
590 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
591 1.1 skrll num_group += 1;
592 1.1 skrll
593 1.1 skrll /* Read the raw contents. */
594 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
595 1.1 skrll amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
596 1.3 christos shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
597 1.3 christos bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
598 1.1 skrll /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
599 1.1 skrll if (shdr->contents == NULL)
600 1.1 skrll {
601 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
602 1.1 skrll (_("%B: Corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
603 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
604 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
605 1.1 skrll }
606 1.1 skrll
607 1.1 skrll memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
608 1.1 skrll
609 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
610 1.1 skrll || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
611 1.1 skrll != shdr->sh_size))
612 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
613 1.1 skrll
614 1.1 skrll /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
615 1.1 skrll array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
616 1.1 skrll to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
617 1.1 skrll pointers. */
618 1.1 skrll src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
619 1.1 skrll dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
620 1.1 skrll while (1)
621 1.1 skrll {
622 1.1 skrll unsigned int idx;
623 1.1 skrll
624 1.1 skrll src -= 4;
625 1.1 skrll --dest;
626 1.1 skrll idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
627 1.1 skrll if (src == shdr->contents)
628 1.1 skrll {
629 1.1 skrll dest->flags = idx;
630 1.1 skrll if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
631 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->flags
632 1.1 skrll |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
633 1.1 skrll break;
634 1.1 skrll }
635 1.1 skrll if (idx >= shnum)
636 1.1 skrll {
637 1.1 skrll ((*_bfd_error_handler)
638 1.1 skrll (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
639 1.1 skrll idx = 0;
640 1.1 skrll }
641 1.1 skrll dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
642 1.1 skrll }
643 1.1 skrll }
644 1.1 skrll }
645 1.1 skrll }
646 1.1 skrll }
647 1.1 skrll
648 1.1 skrll if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
649 1.1 skrll {
650 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
651 1.1 skrll
652 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
653 1.1 skrll {
654 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
655 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
656 1.1 skrll unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
657 1.1 skrll
658 1.1 skrll /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
659 1.1 skrll section is a member. */
660 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
661 1.1 skrll if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
662 1.1 skrll {
663 1.1 skrll asection *s = NULL;
664 1.1 skrll
665 1.1 skrll /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
666 1.1 skrll other members to see if any others are linked via
667 1.1 skrll next_in_group. */
668 1.1 skrll idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
669 1.1 skrll n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
670 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
671 1.1 skrll if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
672 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
673 1.1 skrll break;
674 1.1 skrll if (n_elt != 0)
675 1.1 skrll {
676 1.1 skrll /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
677 1.1 skrll insert current section in circular list. */
678 1.1 skrll elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
679 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
680 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
681 1.1 skrll }
682 1.1 skrll else
683 1.1 skrll {
684 1.1 skrll const char *gname;
685 1.1 skrll
686 1.1 skrll gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
687 1.1 skrll if (gname == NULL)
688 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
689 1.1 skrll elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
690 1.1 skrll
691 1.1 skrll /* Start a circular list with one element. */
692 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
693 1.1 skrll }
694 1.1 skrll
695 1.1 skrll /* If the group section has been created, point to the
696 1.1 skrll new member. */
697 1.1 skrll if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
698 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
699 1.1 skrll
700 1.1 skrll i = num_group - 1;
701 1.1 skrll break;
702 1.1 skrll }
703 1.1 skrll }
704 1.1 skrll }
705 1.1 skrll
706 1.1 skrll if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
707 1.1 skrll {
708 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
709 1.1 skrll abfd, newsect);
710 1.1 skrll }
711 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
712 1.1 skrll }
713 1.1 skrll
714 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
715 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
716 1.1 skrll {
717 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
718 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
719 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
720 1.1 skrll asection *s;
721 1.1 skrll
722 1.1 skrll /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
723 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
724 1.1 skrll {
725 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
726 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
727 1.1 skrll {
728 1.1 skrll unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
729 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
730 1.1 skrll not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
731 1.1 skrll get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
732 1.1 skrll if (elfsec == 0)
733 1.1 skrll {
734 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
735 1.1 skrll if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
736 1.1 skrll bed->link_order_error_handler
737 1.1 skrll (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
738 1.1 skrll abfd, s);
739 1.1 skrll }
740 1.1 skrll else
741 1.1 skrll {
742 1.3 christos asection *linksec = NULL;
743 1.1 skrll
744 1.1 skrll if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
745 1.1 skrll {
746 1.1 skrll this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
747 1.3 christos linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
748 1.1 skrll }
749 1.1 skrll
750 1.1 skrll /* PR 1991, 2008:
751 1.1 skrll Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
752 1.1 skrll sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
753 1.3 christos if (linksec == NULL)
754 1.1 skrll {
755 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
756 1.1 skrll (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
757 1.1 skrll s->owner, s, elfsec);
758 1.1 skrll result = FALSE;
759 1.1 skrll }
760 1.1 skrll
761 1.3 christos elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
762 1.1 skrll }
763 1.1 skrll }
764 1.1 skrll }
765 1.1 skrll
766 1.1 skrll /* Process section groups. */
767 1.1 skrll if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
768 1.1 skrll return result;
769 1.1 skrll
770 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
771 1.1 skrll {
772 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
773 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
774 1.1 skrll unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
775 1.1 skrll
776 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
777 1.1 skrll if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
778 1.1 skrll elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
779 1.1 skrll else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
780 1.1 skrll || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
781 1.1 skrll /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
782 1.1 skrll output object files. We adjust the group section size here
783 1.1 skrll so that relocatable link will work correctly when
784 1.1 skrll relocation sections are in section group in input object
785 1.1 skrll files. */
786 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
787 1.1 skrll else
788 1.1 skrll {
789 1.1 skrll /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
790 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
791 1.1 skrll (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
792 1.1 skrll abfd,
793 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
794 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
795 1.1 skrll (elf_elfheader (abfd)
796 1.1 skrll ->e_shstrndx),
797 1.1 skrll idx->shdr->sh_name),
798 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->name);
799 1.1 skrll result = FALSE;
800 1.1 skrll }
801 1.1 skrll }
802 1.1 skrll return result;
803 1.1 skrll }
804 1.1 skrll
805 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
806 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
807 1.1 skrll {
808 1.1 skrll return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
809 1.1 skrll }
810 1.1 skrll
811 1.1 skrll /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
812 1.1 skrll BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
813 1.1 skrll
814 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
815 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
816 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
817 1.1 skrll const char *name,
818 1.1 skrll int shindex)
819 1.1 skrll {
820 1.1 skrll asection *newsect;
821 1.1 skrll flagword flags;
822 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
823 1.1 skrll
824 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
825 1.3 christos return TRUE;
826 1.1 skrll
827 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
828 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
829 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
830 1.1 skrll
831 1.1 skrll hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
832 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
833 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
834 1.1 skrll
835 1.1 skrll /* Always use the real type/flags. */
836 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
837 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
838 1.1 skrll
839 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
840 1.1 skrll
841 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
842 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
843 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
844 1.1 skrll bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
845 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
846 1.1 skrll
847 1.1 skrll flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
848 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
849 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
850 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
851 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
852 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
853 1.1 skrll {
854 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
855 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
856 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_LOAD;
857 1.1 skrll }
858 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
859 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_READONLY;
860 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
861 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_CODE;
862 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
863 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_DATA;
864 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
865 1.1 skrll {
866 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_MERGE;
867 1.1 skrll newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
868 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
869 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
870 1.1 skrll }
871 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
872 1.1 skrll if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
873 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
874 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
875 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
876 1.3 christos if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
877 1.3 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
878 1.1 skrll
879 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
880 1.1 skrll {
881 1.1 skrll /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
882 1.1 skrll not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
883 1.1 skrll static const struct
884 1.1 skrll {
885 1.1 skrll const char *name;
886 1.1 skrll int len;
887 1.1 skrll } debug_sections [] =
888 1.1 skrll {
889 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("debug") }, /* 'd' */
890 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'e' */
891 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'f' */
892 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("gnu.linkonce.wi.") }, /* 'g' */
893 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'h' */
894 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'i' */
895 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'j' */
896 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'k' */
897 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("line") }, /* 'l' */
898 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'm' */
899 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'n' */
900 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'o' */
901 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'p' */
902 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'q' */
903 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'r' */
904 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("stab") }, /* 's' */
905 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 't' */
906 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'u' */
907 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'v' */
908 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'w' */
909 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'x' */
910 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 }, /* 'y' */
911 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("zdebug") } /* 'z' */
912 1.1 skrll };
913 1.1 skrll
914 1.1 skrll if (name [0] == '.')
915 1.1 skrll {
916 1.1 skrll int i = name [1] - 'd';
917 1.1 skrll if (i >= 0
918 1.1 skrll && i < (int) ARRAY_SIZE (debug_sections)
919 1.1 skrll && debug_sections [i].name != NULL
920 1.1 skrll && strncmp (&name [1], debug_sections [i].name,
921 1.1 skrll debug_sections [i].len) == 0)
922 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
923 1.1 skrll }
924 1.1 skrll }
925 1.1 skrll
926 1.1 skrll /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
927 1.1 skrll only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
928 1.1 skrll g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
929 1.1 skrll The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
930 1.1 skrll are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
931 1.1 skrll all but one of the sections. */
932 1.1 skrll if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
933 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
934 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
935 1.1 skrll
936 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
937 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
938 1.1 skrll if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
939 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
940 1.1 skrll
941 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
942 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
943 1.1 skrll
944 1.1 skrll /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
945 1.1 skrll separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
946 1.1 skrll PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
947 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
948 1.1 skrll {
949 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents;
950 1.1 skrll
951 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
952 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
953 1.1 skrll
954 1.1 skrll elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
955 1.1 skrll free (contents);
956 1.1 skrll }
957 1.1 skrll
958 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
959 1.1 skrll {
960 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
961 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, nload;
962 1.1 skrll
963 1.1 skrll /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
964 1.1 skrll p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
965 1.1 skrll one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
966 1.1 skrll so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
967 1.1 skrll phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
968 1.1 skrll for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
969 1.1 skrll if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
970 1.1 skrll break;
971 1.1 skrll else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
972 1.1 skrll ++nload;
973 1.1 skrll if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
974 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
975 1.1 skrll
976 1.1 skrll phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
977 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
978 1.1 skrll {
979 1.3 christos if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
980 1.3 christos && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
981 1.3 christos || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
982 1.3 christos && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
983 1.1 skrll {
984 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
985 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
986 1.1 skrll + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
987 1.1 skrll else
988 1.1 skrll /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
989 1.1 skrll sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
990 1.1 skrll is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
991 1.1 skrll Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
992 1.1 skrll the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
993 1.1 skrll segment will contain sections with contiguous
994 1.1 skrll LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
995 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
996 1.1 skrll + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
997 1.1 skrll
998 1.1 skrll /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
999 1.1 skrll offsets whether a section with zero size should
1000 1.1 skrll be placed at the end of one segment or the
1001 1.1 skrll beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1002 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1003 1.1 skrll && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1004 1.1 skrll <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1005 1.1 skrll break;
1006 1.1 skrll }
1007 1.1 skrll }
1008 1.1 skrll }
1009 1.1 skrll
1010 1.3 christos /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1011 1.3 christos .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1012 1.3 christos if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1013 1.3 christos && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1014 1.3 christos || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1015 1.3 christos {
1016 1.3 christos enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1017 1.3 christos char *new_name;
1018 1.3 christos
1019 1.3 christos if (bfd_is_section_compressed (abfd, newsect))
1020 1.3 christos {
1021 1.3 christos /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1022 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1023 1.3 christos action = decompress;
1024 1.3 christos }
1025 1.3 christos else
1026 1.3 christos {
1027 1.3 christos /* Normal section. Check if we should compress. */
1028 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS))
1029 1.3 christos action = compress;
1030 1.3 christos }
1031 1.1 skrll
1032 1.3 christos new_name = NULL;
1033 1.3 christos switch (action)
1034 1.3 christos {
1035 1.3 christos case nothing:
1036 1.3 christos break;
1037 1.3 christos case compress:
1038 1.3 christos if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1039 1.3 christos {
1040 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1041 1.3 christos (_("%B: unable to initialize commpress status for section %s"),
1042 1.3 christos abfd, name);
1043 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1044 1.3 christos }
1045 1.3 christos if (name[1] != 'z')
1046 1.3 christos {
1047 1.3 christos unsigned int len = strlen (name);
1048 1.1 skrll
1049 1.3 christos new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
1050 1.3 christos if (new_name == NULL)
1051 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1052 1.3 christos new_name[0] = '.';
1053 1.3 christos new_name[1] = 'z';
1054 1.3 christos memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
1055 1.3 christos }
1056 1.3 christos break;
1057 1.3 christos case decompress:
1058 1.3 christos if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1059 1.3 christos {
1060 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1061 1.3 christos (_("%B: unable to initialize decommpress status for section %s"),
1062 1.3 christos abfd, name);
1063 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1064 1.3 christos }
1065 1.3 christos if (name[1] == 'z')
1066 1.3 christos {
1067 1.3 christos unsigned int len = strlen (name);
1068 1.1 skrll
1069 1.3 christos new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
1070 1.3 christos if (new_name == NULL)
1071 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1072 1.3 christos new_name[0] = '.';
1073 1.3 christos memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
1074 1.3 christos }
1075 1.3 christos break;
1076 1.1 skrll }
1077 1.3 christos if (new_name != NULL)
1078 1.3 christos bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1079 1.1 skrll }
1080 1.3 christos
1081 1.3 christos return TRUE;
1082 1.1 skrll }
1083 1.1 skrll
1084 1.1 skrll const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
1085 1.1 skrll "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1086 1.1 skrll "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1087 1.1 skrll "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1088 1.1 skrll };
1089 1.1 skrll
1090 1.1 skrll /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1091 1.1 skrll output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1092 1.1 skrll has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1093 1.1 skrll be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1094 1.1 skrll change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1095 1.1 skrll all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1096 1.1 skrll into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1097 1.1 skrll function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1098 1.1 skrll relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1099 1.1 skrll
1100 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
1101 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1102 1.1 skrll arelent *reloc_entry,
1103 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
1104 1.1 skrll void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1105 1.1 skrll asection *input_section,
1106 1.1 skrll bfd *output_bfd,
1107 1.1 skrll char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1108 1.1 skrll {
1109 1.1 skrll if (output_bfd != NULL
1110 1.1 skrll && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1111 1.1 skrll && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1112 1.1 skrll || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1113 1.1 skrll {
1114 1.1 skrll reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1115 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_ok;
1116 1.1 skrll }
1117 1.1 skrll
1118 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_continue;
1119 1.1 skrll }
1120 1.1 skrll
1121 1.1 skrll /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1123 1.1 skrll another. */
1124 1.1 skrll
1125 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1126 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1127 1.1 skrll {
1128 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1129 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1130 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1131 1.1 skrll
1132 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (obfd)
1133 1.1 skrll || (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
1134 1.1 skrll == elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags));
1135 1.1 skrll
1136 1.1 skrll elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1137 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1138 1.1 skrll elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1139 1.1 skrll
1140 1.1 skrll /* Copy object attributes. */
1141 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1142 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1143 1.1 skrll }
1144 1.1 skrll
1145 1.1 skrll static const char *
1146 1.1 skrll get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1147 1.1 skrll {
1148 1.1 skrll const char *pt;
1149 1.1 skrll switch (p_type)
1150 1.1 skrll {
1151 1.1 skrll case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1152 1.1 skrll case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1153 1.1 skrll case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1154 1.1 skrll case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1155 1.1 skrll case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1156 1.1 skrll case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1157 1.1 skrll case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1158 1.1 skrll case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1159 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1160 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1161 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1162 1.1 skrll default: pt = NULL; break;
1163 1.1 skrll }
1164 1.1 skrll return pt;
1165 1.1 skrll }
1166 1.1 skrll
1167 1.1 skrll /* Print out the program headers. */
1168 1.1 skrll
1169 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1170 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1171 1.3 christos {
1172 1.1 skrll FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1173 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1174 1.1 skrll asection *s;
1175 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1176 1.1 skrll
1177 1.1 skrll p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1178 1.1 skrll if (p != NULL)
1179 1.1 skrll {
1180 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, c;
1181 1.1 skrll
1182 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1183 1.1 skrll c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1184 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1185 1.1 skrll {
1186 1.1 skrll const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1187 1.1 skrll char buf[20];
1188 1.1 skrll
1189 1.1 skrll if (pt == NULL)
1190 1.1 skrll {
1191 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1192 1.1 skrll pt = buf;
1193 1.1 skrll }
1194 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1195 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1196 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1197 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1198 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1199 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1200 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1201 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1202 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1203 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1204 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1205 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1206 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1207 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1208 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1209 1.1 skrll if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1210 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1211 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1212 1.1 skrll }
1213 1.1 skrll }
1214 1.1 skrll
1215 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1216 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
1217 1.1 skrll {
1218 1.1 skrll unsigned int elfsec;
1219 1.1 skrll unsigned long shlink;
1220 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1221 1.1 skrll size_t extdynsize;
1222 1.1 skrll void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1223 1.1 skrll
1224 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1225 1.1 skrll
1226 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1227 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1228 1.1 skrll
1229 1.1 skrll elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1230 1.1 skrll if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1231 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1232 1.1 skrll shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1233 1.1 skrll
1234 1.1 skrll extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1235 1.1 skrll swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1236 1.1 skrll
1237 1.1 skrll extdyn = dynbuf;
1238 1.1 skrll extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1239 1.1 skrll for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1240 1.1 skrll {
1241 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1242 1.1 skrll const char *name = "";
1243 1.1 skrll char ab[20];
1244 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean stringp;
1245 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1246 1.1 skrll
1247 1.1 skrll (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1248 1.1 skrll
1249 1.1 skrll if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1250 1.1 skrll break;
1251 1.1 skrll
1252 1.1 skrll stringp = FALSE;
1253 1.1 skrll switch (dyn.d_tag)
1254 1.1 skrll {
1255 1.1 skrll default:
1256 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1257 1.1 skrll name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1258 1.1 skrll
1259 1.1 skrll if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1260 1.1 skrll {
1261 1.1 skrll sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1262 1.1 skrll name = ab;
1263 1.1 skrll }
1264 1.1 skrll break;
1265 1.1 skrll
1266 1.1 skrll case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1267 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1268 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1269 1.1 skrll case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1270 1.1 skrll case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1271 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1272 1.1 skrll case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1273 1.1 skrll case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1274 1.1 skrll case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1275 1.1 skrll case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1276 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1277 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1278 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1279 1.1 skrll case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1280 1.1 skrll case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1281 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1282 1.1 skrll case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1283 1.1 skrll case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1284 1.1 skrll case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1285 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1286 1.1 skrll case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1287 1.1 skrll case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1288 1.1 skrll case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1289 1.1 skrll case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1290 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1291 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1292 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1293 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1294 1.1 skrll case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1295 1.1 skrll case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1296 1.1 skrll case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1297 1.1 skrll case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1298 1.1 skrll case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1299 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1300 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1301 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1302 1.1 skrll case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1303 1.1 skrll case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1304 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1305 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1306 1.1 skrll case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1307 1.1 skrll case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1308 1.1 skrll case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1309 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1310 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1311 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1312 1.1 skrll case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1313 1.1 skrll case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1314 1.1 skrll case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1315 1.1 skrll case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1316 1.1 skrll case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1317 1.1 skrll case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1318 1.1 skrll case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1319 1.1 skrll case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1320 1.1 skrll case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1321 1.1 skrll case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1322 1.1 skrll case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1323 1.1 skrll case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1324 1.1 skrll }
1325 1.1 skrll
1326 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1327 1.1 skrll if (! stringp)
1328 1.1 skrll {
1329 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "0x");
1330 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1331 1.1 skrll }
1332 1.1 skrll else
1333 1.1 skrll {
1334 1.1 skrll const char *string;
1335 1.1 skrll unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1336 1.1 skrll
1337 1.1 skrll string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1338 1.1 skrll if (string == NULL)
1339 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1340 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1341 1.1 skrll }
1342 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1343 1.1 skrll }
1344 1.1 skrll
1345 1.1 skrll free (dynbuf);
1346 1.1 skrll dynbuf = NULL;
1347 1.1 skrll }
1348 1.1 skrll
1349 1.1 skrll if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1350 1.1 skrll || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1351 1.1 skrll {
1352 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1353 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1354 1.1 skrll }
1355 1.1 skrll
1356 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1357 1.1 skrll {
1358 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1359 1.1 skrll
1360 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1361 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1362 1.1 skrll {
1363 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1364 1.1 skrll t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1365 1.1 skrll t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1366 1.1 skrll if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1367 1.1 skrll {
1368 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1369 1.1 skrll
1370 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\t");
1371 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1372 1.1 skrll a != NULL;
1373 1.1 skrll a = a->vda_nextptr)
1374 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%s ",
1375 1.1 skrll a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1376 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1377 1.1 skrll }
1378 1.1 skrll }
1379 1.1 skrll }
1380 1.1 skrll
1381 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1382 1.1 skrll {
1383 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1384 1.1 skrll
1385 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1386 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1387 1.1 skrll {
1388 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1389 1.1 skrll
1390 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1391 1.1 skrll t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1392 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1393 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1394 1.1 skrll a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1395 1.1 skrll a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1396 1.1 skrll }
1397 1.1 skrll }
1398 1.1 skrll
1399 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1400 1.1 skrll
1401 1.1 skrll error_return:
1402 1.1 skrll if (dynbuf != NULL)
1403 1.1 skrll free (dynbuf);
1404 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1405 1.1 skrll }
1406 1.1 skrll
1407 1.1 skrll /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1408 1.1 skrll
1409 1.1 skrll void
1410 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1411 1.1 skrll void *filep,
1412 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
1413 1.1 skrll bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1414 1.3 christos {
1415 1.1 skrll FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1416 1.1 skrll switch (how)
1417 1.1 skrll {
1418 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1419 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1420 1.1 skrll break;
1421 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1422 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, "elf ");
1423 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1424 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
1425 1.1 skrll break;
1426 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1427 1.1 skrll {
1428 1.1 skrll const char *section_name;
1429 1.1 skrll const char *name = NULL;
1430 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1431 1.1 skrll unsigned char st_other;
1432 1.1 skrll bfd_vma val;
1433 1.1 skrll
1434 1.1 skrll section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1435 1.1 skrll
1436 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1437 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1438 1.1 skrll name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1439 1.1 skrll
1440 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
1441 1.1 skrll {
1442 1.1 skrll name = symbol->name;
1443 1.1 skrll bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1444 1.1 skrll }
1445 1.1 skrll
1446 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1447 1.1 skrll /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1448 1.1 skrll we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1449 1.1 skrll For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1450 1.1 skrll we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1451 1.1 skrll if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1452 1.1 skrll val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1453 1.1 skrll else
1454 1.1 skrll val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1455 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1456 1.1 skrll
1457 1.1 skrll /* If we have version information, print it. */
1458 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_section != 0
1459 1.1 skrll && (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_section != 0
1460 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_section != 0))
1461 1.1 skrll {
1462 1.1 skrll unsigned int vernum;
1463 1.1 skrll const char *version_string;
1464 1.1 skrll
1465 1.1 skrll vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_VERSION;
1466 1.1 skrll
1467 1.1 skrll if (vernum == 0)
1468 1.1 skrll version_string = "";
1469 1.1 skrll else if (vernum == 1)
1470 1.1 skrll version_string = "Base";
1471 1.1 skrll else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1472 1.1 skrll version_string =
1473 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1474 1.1 skrll else
1475 1.1 skrll {
1476 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1477 1.1 skrll
1478 1.1 skrll version_string = "";
1479 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1480 1.1 skrll t != NULL;
1481 1.1 skrll t = t->vn_nextref)
1482 1.1 skrll {
1483 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1484 1.1 skrll
1485 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1486 1.1 skrll {
1487 1.1 skrll if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1488 1.1 skrll {
1489 1.1 skrll version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1490 1.1 skrll break;
1491 1.1 skrll }
1492 1.1 skrll }
1493 1.1 skrll }
1494 1.1 skrll }
1495 1.1 skrll
1496 1.1 skrll if ((((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_HIDDEN) == 0)
1497 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1498 1.1 skrll else
1499 1.1 skrll {
1500 1.1 skrll int i;
1501 1.1 skrll
1502 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1503 1.1 skrll for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1504 1.1 skrll putc (' ', file);
1505 1.1 skrll }
1506 1.1 skrll }
1507 1.1 skrll
1508 1.1 skrll /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1509 1.1 skrll st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1510 1.1 skrll
1511 1.1 skrll switch (st_other)
1512 1.1 skrll {
1513 1.1 skrll case 0: break;
1514 1.1 skrll case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1515 1.1 skrll case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1516 1.1 skrll case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1517 1.1 skrll default:
1518 1.1 skrll /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1519 1.1 skrll everything hex. */
1520 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1521 1.1 skrll }
1522 1.1 skrll
1523 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1524 1.1 skrll }
1525 1.1 skrll break;
1526 1.1 skrll }
1527 1.1 skrll }
1528 1.1 skrll
1529 1.1 skrll /* Allocate an ELF string table--force the first byte to be zero. */
1530 1.1 skrll
1531 1.1 skrll struct bfd_strtab_hash *
1532 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_stringtab_init (void)
1533 1.1 skrll {
1534 1.1 skrll struct bfd_strtab_hash *ret;
1535 1.1 skrll
1536 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_stringtab_init ();
1537 1.1 skrll if (ret != NULL)
1538 1.1 skrll {
1539 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type loc;
1540 1.1 skrll
1541 1.1 skrll loc = _bfd_stringtab_add (ret, "", TRUE, FALSE);
1542 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (loc == 0 || loc == (bfd_size_type) -1);
1543 1.1 skrll if (loc == (bfd_size_type) -1)
1544 1.1 skrll {
1545 1.1 skrll _bfd_stringtab_free (ret);
1546 1.1 skrll ret = NULL;
1547 1.1 skrll }
1548 1.1 skrll }
1549 1.1 skrll return ret;
1550 1.1 skrll }
1551 1.1 skrll
1552 1.1 skrll /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1554 1.1 skrll
1555 1.1 skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1556 1.1 skrll
1557 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1558 1.1 skrll bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1559 1.1 skrll {
1560 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1561 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1562 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1563 1.1 skrll const char *name;
1564 1.1 skrll
1565 1.1 skrll if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1566 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1567 1.1 skrll
1568 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1569 1.1 skrll ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1570 1.1 skrll name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
1571 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_name);
1572 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
1573 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1574 1.1 skrll
1575 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1576 1.1 skrll switch (hdr->sh_type)
1577 1.1 skrll {
1578 1.1 skrll case SHT_NULL:
1579 1.1 skrll /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
1580 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1581 1.1 skrll
1582 1.1 skrll case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
1583 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
1584 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
1585 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
1586 1.1 skrll case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
1587 1.1 skrll case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
1588 1.1 skrll case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
1589 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
1590 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
1591 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1592 1.1 skrll
1593 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
1594 1.3 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1595 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1596 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
1597 1.3 christos {
1598 1.3 christos /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
1599 1.3 christos field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
1600 1.3 christos switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
1601 1.3 christos {
1602 1.3 christos case bfd_arch_i386:
1603 1.3 christos case bfd_arch_sparc:
1604 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
1605 1.3 christos || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
1606 1.3 christos break;
1607 1.3 christos /* Otherwise fall through. */
1608 1.3 christos default:
1609 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1610 1.3 christos }
1611 1.1 skrll }
1612 1.3 christos else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
1613 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1614 1.1 skrll else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
1615 1.1 skrll {
1616 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
1617 1.1 skrll
1618 1.1 skrll /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
1619 1.1 skrll sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
1620 1.1 skrll string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
1621 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1622 1.1 skrll {
1623 1.1 skrll dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
1624 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1625 1.1 skrll }
1626 1.1 skrll else
1627 1.1 skrll {
1628 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
1629 1.1 skrll
1630 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1631 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1632 1.1 skrll {
1633 1.1 skrll dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1634 1.1 skrll if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1635 1.1 skrll {
1636 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1637 1.1 skrll break;
1638 1.1 skrll }
1639 1.1 skrll }
1640 1.1 skrll }
1641 1.1 skrll }
1642 1.1 skrll break;
1643 1.1 skrll
1644 1.1 skrll case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table */
1645 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1646 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1647 1.1 skrll
1648 1.2 skrll if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1649 1.2 skrll return FALSE;
1650 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1651 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1652 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0);
1653 1.1 skrll elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1654 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr = *hdr;
1655 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1656 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1657 1.1 skrll
1658 1.1 skrll /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
1659 1.1 skrll SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
1660 1.1 skrll treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
1661 1.1 skrll decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
1662 1.1 skrll set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
1663 1.1 skrll linker. */
1664 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
1665 1.1 skrll && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
1666 1.1 skrll && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1667 1.1 skrll shindex))
1668 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1669 1.1 skrll
1670 1.1 skrll /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
1671 1.1 skrll can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
1672 1.1 skrll is most likely specified by the next section header. */
1673 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]->sh_link != shindex)
1674 1.1 skrll {
1675 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
1676 1.1 skrll
1677 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1678 1.1 skrll for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1679 1.1 skrll {
1680 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1681 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1682 1.1 skrll && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1683 1.1 skrll break;
1684 1.1 skrll }
1685 1.1 skrll if (i == num_sec)
1686 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
1687 1.1 skrll {
1688 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1689 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1690 1.1 skrll && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1691 1.1 skrll break;
1692 1.1 skrll }
1693 1.1 skrll if (i != shindex)
1694 1.1 skrll return bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
1695 1.1 skrll }
1696 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1697 1.1 skrll
1698 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table */
1699 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1700 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1701 1.1 skrll
1702 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1703 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1704 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0);
1705 1.1 skrll elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1706 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
1707 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
1708 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1709 1.1 skrll
1710 1.1 skrll /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
1711 1.1 skrll section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
1712 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1713 1.1 skrll
1714 1.1 skrll case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections */
1715 1.1 skrll if (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == shindex)
1716 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1717 1.1 skrll
1718 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == 0);
1719 1.1 skrll elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = shindex;
1720 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr = *hdr;
1721 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
1722 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1723 1.1 skrll
1724 1.1 skrll case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table */
1725 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1726 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1727 1.1 skrll if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
1728 1.1 skrll {
1729 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1730 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
1731 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1732 1.1 skrll }
1733 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1734 1.1 skrll {
1735 1.1 skrll symtab_strtab:
1736 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
1737 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
1738 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1739 1.1 skrll }
1740 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1741 1.1 skrll {
1742 1.1 skrll dynsymtab_strtab:
1743 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1744 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
1745 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
1746 1.1 skrll /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
1747 1.1 skrll can handle it. */
1748 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1749 1.1 skrll shindex);
1750 1.1 skrll }
1751 1.1 skrll
1752 1.1 skrll /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
1753 1.1 skrll regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
1754 1.1 skrll just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
1755 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
1756 1.1 skrll {
1757 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
1758 1.1 skrll
1759 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1760 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1761 1.1 skrll {
1762 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1763 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1764 1.1 skrll {
1765 1.1 skrll /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
1766 1.1 skrll if (i == shindex)
1767 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1768 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
1769 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1770 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
1771 1.1 skrll goto symtab_strtab;
1772 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
1773 1.1 skrll goto dynsymtab_strtab;
1774 1.1 skrll }
1775 1.1 skrll }
1776 1.1 skrll }
1777 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1778 1.1 skrll
1779 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
1780 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
1781 1.1 skrll /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
1782 1.3 christos {
1783 1.1 skrll asection *target_sect;
1784 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
1785 1.3 christos unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1786 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
1787 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
1788 1.1 skrll
1789 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_entsize
1790 1.1 skrll != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
1791 1.1 skrll ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
1792 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1793 1.1 skrll
1794 1.1 skrll /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
1795 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
1796 1.1 skrll {
1797 1.1 skrll ((*_bfd_error_handler)
1798 1.1 skrll (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
1799 1.1 skrll abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
1800 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1801 1.1 skrll shindex);
1802 1.1 skrll }
1803 1.1 skrll
1804 1.1 skrll /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
1805 1.1 skrll libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
1806 1.1 skrll bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
1807 1.1 skrll reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
1808 1.3 christos them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
1809 1.3 christos one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
1810 1.3 christos to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
1811 1.3 christos
1812 1.3 christos Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
1813 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
1814 1.1 skrll && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
1815 1.1 skrll && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
1816 1.1 skrll {
1817 1.1 skrll unsigned int scan;
1818 1.1 skrll int found;
1819 1.1 skrll
1820 1.1 skrll found = 0;
1821 1.1 skrll for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
1822 1.1 skrll {
1823 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1824 1.1 skrll || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1825 1.1 skrll {
1826 1.1 skrll if (found != 0)
1827 1.1 skrll {
1828 1.1 skrll found = 0;
1829 1.1 skrll break;
1830 1.1 skrll }
1831 1.1 skrll found = scan;
1832 1.1 skrll }
1833 1.1 skrll }
1834 1.1 skrll if (found != 0)
1835 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = found;
1836 1.1 skrll }
1837 1.1 skrll
1838 1.1 skrll /* Get the symbol table. */
1839 1.1 skrll if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1840 1.1 skrll || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1841 1.1 skrll && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
1842 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1843 1.1 skrll
1844 1.1 skrll /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
1845 1.1 skrll don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
1846 1.1 skrll represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
1847 1.3 christos try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
1848 1.3 christos can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
1849 1.1 skrll section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
1850 1.3 christos sh_link points to the null section. */
1851 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
1852 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
1853 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
1854 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
1855 1.1 skrll || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
1856 1.1 skrll || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1857 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1858 1.1 skrll shindex);
1859 1.1 skrll
1860 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
1861 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1862 1.1 skrll target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
1863 1.1 skrll if (target_sect == NULL)
1864 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1865 1.3 christos
1866 1.3 christos esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
1867 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1868 1.3 christos p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
1869 1.3 christos else
1870 1.3 christos p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
1871 1.3 christos
1872 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (*p_hdr == NULL);
1873 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
1874 1.3 christos hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
1875 1.1 skrll if (hdr2 == NULL)
1876 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1877 1.1 skrll *hdr2 = *hdr;
1878 1.1 skrll *p_hdr = hdr2;
1879 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
1880 1.1 skrll target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
1881 1.1 skrll target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
1882 1.1 skrll target_sect->relocation = NULL;
1883 1.1 skrll target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1884 1.1 skrll /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
1885 1.3 christos its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
1886 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1887 1.3 christos {
1888 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1889 1.1 skrll target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
1890 1.1 skrll }
1891 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
1892 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1893 1.1 skrll }
1894 1.1 skrll
1895 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
1896 1.1 skrll elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
1897 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
1898 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1899 1.1 skrll
1900 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
1901 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
1902 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1903 1.1 skrll elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
1904 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
1905 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1906 1.1 skrll
1907 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
1908 1.1 skrll elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
1909 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
1910 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1911 1.1 skrll
1912 1.1 skrll case SHT_SHLIB:
1913 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1914 1.1 skrll
1915 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
1916 1.1 skrll if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr))
1917 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1918 1.1 skrll if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1919 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1920 1.1 skrll if (hdr->contents != NULL)
1921 1.1 skrll {
1922 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
1923 1.1 skrll unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
1924 1.1 skrll asection *s;
1925 1.1 skrll
1926 1.1 skrll if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
1927 1.1 skrll hdr->bfd_section->flags
1928 1.1 skrll |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1929 1.1 skrll
1930 1.1 skrll /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in. */
1931 1.1 skrll idx += n_elt;
1932 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
1933 1.1 skrll {
1934 1.1 skrll --idx;
1935 1.1 skrll
1936 1.1 skrll if (idx->shdr != NULL
1937 1.1 skrll && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
1938 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
1939 1.1 skrll {
1940 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
1941 1.1 skrll break;
1942 1.1 skrll }
1943 1.1 skrll }
1944 1.1 skrll }
1945 1.1 skrll break;
1946 1.1 skrll
1947 1.1 skrll default:
1948 1.1 skrll /* Possibly an attributes section. */
1949 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
1950 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
1951 1.1 skrll {
1952 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1953 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1954 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
1955 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1956 1.1 skrll }
1957 1.1 skrll
1958 1.1 skrll /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
1959 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1960 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1961 1.1 skrll
1962 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
1963 1.1 skrll {
1964 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1965 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
1966 1.1 skrll for applications? */
1967 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
1968 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
1969 1.1 skrll "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
1970 1.1 skrll abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1971 1.1 skrll else
1972 1.1 skrll /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
1973 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1974 1.1 skrll shindex);
1975 1.1 skrll }
1976 1.1 skrll else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
1977 1.1 skrll && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
1978 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
1979 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
1980 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
1981 1.1 skrll "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
1982 1.1 skrll abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1983 1.1 skrll else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
1984 1.1 skrll {
1985 1.1 skrll /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
1986 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
1987 1.1 skrll /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
1988 1.1 skrll required to correctly process the section and the file should
1989 1.1 skrll be rejected with an error message. */
1990 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
1991 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
1992 1.1 skrll "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
1993 1.1 skrll abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1994 1.1 skrll else
1995 1.1 skrll /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
1996 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1997 1.1 skrll }
1998 1.1 skrll else
1999 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2000 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
2001 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2002 1.1 skrll abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2003 1.1 skrll
2004 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2005 1.1 skrll }
2006 1.1 skrll
2007 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2008 1.3 christos }
2009 1.1 skrll
2010 1.3 christos /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2011 1.3 christos
2012 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *
2013 1.3 christos bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2014 1.1 skrll bfd *abfd,
2015 1.1 skrll unsigned long r_symndx)
2016 1.1 skrll {
2017 1.1 skrll unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2018 1.1 skrll
2019 1.1 skrll if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2020 1.1 skrll {
2021 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2022 1.1 skrll unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2023 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2024 1.1 skrll
2025 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2026 1.1 skrll if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2027 1.1 skrll &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2028 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2029 1.1 skrll
2030 1.1 skrll if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2031 1.1 skrll {
2032 1.1 skrll memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2033 1.1 skrll cache->abfd = abfd;
2034 1.1 skrll }
2035 1.1 skrll cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2036 1.3 christos }
2037 1.1 skrll
2038 1.1 skrll return &cache->sym[ent];
2039 1.1 skrll }
2040 1.1 skrll
2041 1.1 skrll /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2042 1.1 skrll section. */
2043 1.3 christos
2044 1.1 skrll asection *
2045 1.3 christos bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2046 1.1 skrll {
2047 1.3 christos if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2048 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2049 1.1 skrll return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2050 1.1 skrll }
2051 1.1 skrll
2052 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2053 1.1 skrll {
2054 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2055 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2056 1.1 skrll };
2057 1.1 skrll
2058 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2059 1.1 skrll {
2060 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2061 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2062 1.1 skrll };
2063 1.1 skrll
2064 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2065 1.1 skrll {
2066 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2067 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2068 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2069 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2070 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2071 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2072 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2073 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2074 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2075 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2076 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2077 1.1 skrll };
2078 1.1 skrll
2079 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2080 1.1 skrll {
2081 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2082 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2083 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2084 1.1 skrll };
2085 1.1 skrll
2086 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2087 1.3 christos {
2088 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2089 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2090 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2091 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2092 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2093 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2094 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2095 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2096 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2097 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2098 1.1 skrll };
2099 1.1 skrll
2100 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2101 1.1 skrll {
2102 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2103 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2104 1.1 skrll };
2105 1.1 skrll
2106 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2107 1.1 skrll {
2108 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2109 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2110 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2111 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2112 1.1 skrll };
2113 1.1 skrll
2114 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2115 1.1 skrll {
2116 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2117 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2118 1.1 skrll };
2119 1.1 skrll
2120 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2121 1.1 skrll {
2122 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2123 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2124 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2125 1.1 skrll };
2126 1.1 skrll
2127 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2128 1.1 skrll {
2129 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2130 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2131 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2132 1.1 skrll };
2133 1.1 skrll
2134 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2135 1.1 skrll {
2136 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2137 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2138 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2139 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2140 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2141 1.1 skrll };
2142 1.1 skrll
2143 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2144 1.1 skrll {
2145 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2146 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2147 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2148 1.1 skrll /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2149 1.1 skrll this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2150 1.1 skrll { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2151 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2152 1.1 skrll };
2153 1.1 skrll
2154 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2155 1.1 skrll {
2156 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2157 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2158 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2159 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2160 1.1 skrll };
2161 1.1 skrll
2162 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2163 1.1 skrll {
2164 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2165 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2166 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2167 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2168 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2169 1.1 skrll };
2170 1.1 skrll
2171 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *special_sections[] =
2172 1.1 skrll {
2173 1.1 skrll special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2174 1.1 skrll special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2175 1.1 skrll special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2176 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'e' */
2177 1.1 skrll special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2178 1.1 skrll special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2179 1.1 skrll special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2180 1.1 skrll special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2181 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'j' */
2182 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'k' */
2183 1.1 skrll special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2184 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'm' */
2185 1.1 skrll special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2186 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'o' */
2187 1.1 skrll special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2188 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'q' */
2189 1.1 skrll special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2190 1.1 skrll special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2191 1.1 skrll special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2192 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'u' */
2193 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'v' */
2194 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'w' */
2195 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'x' */
2196 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'y' */
2197 1.1 skrll special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2198 1.1 skrll };
2199 1.1 skrll
2200 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2201 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2202 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2203 1.1 skrll unsigned int rela)
2204 1.1 skrll {
2205 1.1 skrll int i;
2206 1.1 skrll int len;
2207 1.1 skrll
2208 1.1 skrll len = strlen (name);
2209 1.1 skrll
2210 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2211 1.1 skrll {
2212 1.1 skrll int suffix_len;
2213 1.1 skrll int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2214 1.1 skrll
2215 1.1 skrll if (len < prefix_len)
2216 1.1 skrll continue;
2217 1.1 skrll if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2218 1.1 skrll continue;
2219 1.1 skrll
2220 1.1 skrll suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2221 1.1 skrll if (suffix_len <= 0)
2222 1.1 skrll {
2223 1.1 skrll if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2224 1.1 skrll {
2225 1.1 skrll if (suffix_len == 0)
2226 1.1 skrll continue;
2227 1.1 skrll if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2228 1.1 skrll && (suffix_len == -2
2229 1.1 skrll || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2230 1.1 skrll continue;
2231 1.1 skrll }
2232 1.1 skrll }
2233 1.1 skrll else
2234 1.1 skrll {
2235 1.1 skrll if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2236 1.1 skrll continue;
2237 1.1 skrll if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2238 1.1 skrll spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2239 1.1 skrll suffix_len) != 0)
2240 1.1 skrll continue;
2241 1.1 skrll }
2242 1.1 skrll return &spec[i];
2243 1.1 skrll }
2244 1.1 skrll
2245 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2246 1.1 skrll }
2247 1.1 skrll
2248 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2249 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2250 1.1 skrll {
2251 1.1 skrll int i;
2252 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2253 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2254 1.1 skrll
2255 1.1 skrll /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2256 1.1 skrll if (sec->name == NULL)
2257 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2258 1.1 skrll
2259 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2260 1.1 skrll spec = bed->special_sections;
2261 1.1 skrll if (spec)
2262 1.1 skrll {
2263 1.1 skrll spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2264 1.1 skrll bed->special_sections,
2265 1.1 skrll sec->use_rela_p);
2266 1.1 skrll if (spec != NULL)
2267 1.1 skrll return spec;
2268 1.1 skrll }
2269 1.1 skrll
2270 1.1 skrll if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2271 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2272 1.1 skrll
2273 1.1 skrll i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2274 1.1 skrll if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2275 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2276 1.1 skrll
2277 1.1 skrll spec = special_sections[i];
2278 1.1 skrll
2279 1.1 skrll if (spec == NULL)
2280 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2281 1.1 skrll
2282 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2283 1.1 skrll }
2284 1.1 skrll
2285 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2286 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2287 1.1 skrll {
2288 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2289 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2290 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2291 1.1 skrll
2292 1.1 skrll sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2293 1.3 christos if (sdata == NULL)
2294 1.3 christos {
2295 1.1 skrll sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2296 1.1 skrll sizeof (*sdata));
2297 1.1 skrll if (sdata == NULL)
2298 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2299 1.1 skrll sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2300 1.1 skrll }
2301 1.1 skrll
2302 1.1 skrll /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2303 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2304 1.1 skrll sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2305 1.1 skrll
2306 1.1 skrll /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2307 1.1 skrll flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2308 1.1 skrll anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2309 1.1 skrll created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2310 1.1 skrll set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2311 1.1 skrll elf_fake_sections. */
2312 1.1 skrll if ((!sec->flags && abfd->direction != read_direction)
2313 1.1 skrll || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2314 1.1 skrll {
2315 1.1 skrll ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2316 1.1 skrll if (ssect != NULL)
2317 1.1 skrll {
2318 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2319 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2320 1.1 skrll }
2321 1.1 skrll }
2322 1.1 skrll
2323 1.1 skrll return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2324 1.1 skrll }
2325 1.1 skrll
2326 1.1 skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2327 1.1 skrll
2328 1.1 skrll Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2329 1.1 skrll of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2330 1.1 skrll program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2331 1.1 skrll generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2332 1.1 skrll
2333 1.1 skrll Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2334 1.1 skrll (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2335 1.1 skrll system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2336 1.1 skrll but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2337 1.1 skrll file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2338 1.1 skrll of combined data+bss.
2339 1.1 skrll
2340 1.1 skrll To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2341 1.1 skrll for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2342 1.1 skrll the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2343 1.1 skrll by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2344 1.1 skrll into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2345 1.1 skrll
2346 1.1 skrll */
2347 1.1 skrll
2348 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2349 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2350 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2351 1.1 skrll int hdr_index,
2352 1.1 skrll const char *type_name)
2353 1.1 skrll {
2354 1.1 skrll asection *newsect;
2355 1.1 skrll char *name;
2356 1.1 skrll char namebuf[64];
2357 1.1 skrll size_t len;
2358 1.1 skrll int split;
2359 1.1 skrll
2360 1.1 skrll split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2361 1.1 skrll && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2362 1.1 skrll && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2363 1.1 skrll
2364 1.3 christos if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2365 1.1 skrll {
2366 1.3 christos sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2367 1.1 skrll len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2368 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2369 1.1 skrll if (!name)
2370 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2371 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2372 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2373 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
2374 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2375 1.1 skrll newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2376 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2377 1.1 skrll newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2378 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2379 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2380 1.1 skrll newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2381 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2382 1.1 skrll {
2383 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2384 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2385 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2386 1.1 skrll {
2387 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2388 1.1 skrll may be data. */
2389 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2390 1.1 skrll }
2391 1.1 skrll }
2392 1.1 skrll if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2393 1.1 skrll {
2394 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2395 1.1 skrll }
2396 1.1 skrll }
2397 1.1 skrll
2398 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2399 1.1 skrll {
2400 1.3 christos bfd_vma align;
2401 1.1 skrll
2402 1.3 christos sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2403 1.1 skrll len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2404 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2405 1.1 skrll if (!name)
2406 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2407 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2408 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2409 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
2410 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2411 1.1 skrll newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2412 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2413 1.1 skrll newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2414 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2415 1.1 skrll align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2416 1.1 skrll if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2417 1.1 skrll align = hdr->p_align;
2418 1.1 skrll newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2419 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2420 1.1 skrll {
2421 1.1 skrll /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2422 1.1 skrll not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2423 1.1 skrll assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2424 1.1 skrll executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2425 1.1 skrll section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2426 1.1 skrll always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2427 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2428 1.1 skrll newsect->size = 0;
2429 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2430 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2431 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2432 1.1 skrll }
2433 1.1 skrll if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2434 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2435 1.1 skrll }
2436 1.1 skrll
2437 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2438 1.1 skrll }
2439 1.3 christos
2440 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2441 1.1 skrll bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2442 1.1 skrll {
2443 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2444 1.1 skrll
2445 1.1 skrll switch (hdr->p_type)
2446 1.3 christos {
2447 1.1 skrll case PT_NULL:
2448 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2449 1.3 christos
2450 1.1 skrll case PT_LOAD:
2451 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2452 1.3 christos
2453 1.1 skrll case PT_DYNAMIC:
2454 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2455 1.3 christos
2456 1.1 skrll case PT_INTERP:
2457 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2458 1.3 christos
2459 1.1 skrll case PT_NOTE:
2460 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2461 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2462 1.1 skrll if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2463 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2464 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2465 1.3 christos
2466 1.1 skrll case PT_SHLIB:
2467 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2468 1.3 christos
2469 1.1 skrll case PT_PHDR:
2470 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
2471 1.3 christos
2472 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
2473 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
2474 1.1 skrll "eh_frame_hdr");
2475 1.3 christos
2476 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_STACK:
2477 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
2478 1.3 christos
2479 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_RELRO:
2480 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
2481 1.1 skrll
2482 1.1 skrll default:
2483 1.3 christos /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
2484 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2485 1.1 skrll return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
2486 1.1 skrll }
2487 1.3 christos }
2488 1.3 christos
2489 1.3 christos /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
2490 1.3 christos REL or RELA. */
2491 1.3 christos
2492 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *
2493 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
2494 1.3 christos {
2495 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
2496 1.3 christos {
2497 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
2498 1.3 christos return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
2499 1.3 christos }
2500 1.3 christos else
2501 1.3 christos return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
2502 1.3 christos }
2503 1.3 christos
2504 1.3 christos /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
2505 1.3 christos containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
2506 1.1 skrll USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
2507 1.1 skrll relocations. */
2508 1.1 skrll
2509 1.3 christos bfd_boolean
2510 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
2511 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
2512 1.1 skrll asection *asect,
2513 1.3 christos bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
2514 1.1 skrll {
2515 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
2516 1.3 christos char *name;
2517 1.3 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2518 1.3 christos bfd_size_type amt;
2519 1.3 christos
2520 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
2521 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
2522 1.1 skrll rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2523 1.3 christos reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
2524 1.3 christos
2525 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof ".rela" + strlen (asect->name);
2526 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2527 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
2528 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2529 1.1 skrll sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", asect->name);
2530 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_name =
2531 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
2532 1.1 skrll FALSE);
2533 1.1 skrll if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2534 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2535 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
2536 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
2537 1.1 skrll ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
2538 1.1 skrll : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
2539 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
2540 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
2541 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2542 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2543 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2544 1.1 skrll
2545 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2546 1.3 christos }
2547 1.3 christos
2548 1.3 christos /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
2549 1.3 christos
2550 1.3 christos int
2551 1.3 christos bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
2552 1.3 christos {
2553 1.3 christos if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2554 1.3 christos && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
2555 1.3 christos return SHT_NOBITS;
2556 1.3 christos return SHT_PROGBITS;
2557 1.3 christos }
2558 1.3 christos
2559 1.3 christos struct fake_section_arg
2560 1.3 christos {
2561 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
2562 1.3 christos bfd_boolean failed;
2563 1.1 skrll };
2564 1.1 skrll
2565 1.1 skrll /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
2566 1.3 christos
2567 1.1 skrll static void
2568 1.3 christos elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
2569 1.1 skrll {
2570 1.3 christos struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
2571 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2572 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
2573 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
2574 1.3 christos unsigned int sh_type;
2575 1.1 skrll
2576 1.1 skrll if (arg->failed)
2577 1.1 skrll {
2578 1.1 skrll /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
2579 1.1 skrll loop. */
2580 1.1 skrll return;
2581 1.3 christos }
2582 1.1 skrll
2583 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
2584 1.1 skrll
2585 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2586 1.1 skrll asect->name, FALSE);
2587 1.3 christos if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2588 1.1 skrll {
2589 1.1 skrll arg->failed = TRUE;
2590 1.1 skrll return;
2591 1.1 skrll }
2592 1.1 skrll
2593 1.1 skrll /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
2594 1.1 skrll
2595 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2596 1.1 skrll || asect->user_set_vma)
2597 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
2598 1.1 skrll else
2599 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2600 1.1 skrll
2601 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2602 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
2603 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
2604 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
2605 1.1 skrll /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
2606 1.1 skrll copy_private_section_data. */
2607 1.1 skrll
2608 1.1 skrll this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
2609 1.1 skrll this_hdr->contents = NULL;
2610 1.1 skrll
2611 1.1 skrll /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
2612 1.1 skrll asect->flags. */
2613 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
2614 1.3 christos sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
2615 1.1 skrll else
2616 1.1 skrll sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
2617 1.1 skrll
2618 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
2619 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2620 1.1 skrll else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
2621 1.1 skrll && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
2622 1.1 skrll && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2623 1.1 skrll {
2624 1.1 skrll /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
2625 1.1 skrll allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
2626 1.1 skrll non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
2627 1.1 skrll to a bss output section via a linker script. */
2628 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
2629 1.1 skrll (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
2630 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2631 1.1 skrll }
2632 1.1 skrll
2633 1.1 skrll switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
2634 1.1 skrll {
2635 1.1 skrll default:
2636 1.1 skrll break;
2637 1.1 skrll
2638 1.1 skrll case SHT_STRTAB:
2639 1.1 skrll case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
2640 1.1 skrll case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
2641 1.1 skrll case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
2642 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOTE:
2643 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOBITS:
2644 1.1 skrll case SHT_PROGBITS:
2645 1.1 skrll break;
2646 1.1 skrll
2647 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH:
2648 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
2649 1.1 skrll break;
2650 1.1 skrll
2651 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM:
2652 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
2653 1.1 skrll break;
2654 1.1 skrll
2655 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC:
2656 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
2657 1.1 skrll break;
2658 1.1 skrll
2659 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
2660 1.1 skrll if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
2661 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
2662 1.1 skrll break;
2663 1.1 skrll
2664 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
2665 1.1 skrll if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
2666 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
2667 1.1 skrll break;
2668 1.1 skrll
2669 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
2670 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
2671 1.1 skrll break;
2672 1.1 skrll
2673 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2674 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2675 1.1 skrll /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2676 1.1 skrll cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
2677 1.1 skrll zero. */
2678 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2679 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
2680 1.1 skrll else
2681 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
2682 1.1 skrll || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
2683 1.1 skrll break;
2684 1.1 skrll
2685 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2686 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2687 1.1 skrll /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2688 1.1 skrll cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
2689 1.1 skrll zero. */
2690 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2691 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
2692 1.1 skrll else
2693 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
2694 1.1 skrll || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
2695 1.1 skrll break;
2696 1.1 skrll
2697 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
2698 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
2699 1.1 skrll break;
2700 1.1 skrll
2701 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH:
2702 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
2703 1.1 skrll break;
2704 1.1 skrll }
2705 1.1 skrll
2706 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2707 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
2708 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
2709 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
2710 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2711 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
2712 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
2713 1.1 skrll {
2714 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
2715 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
2716 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
2717 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
2718 1.1 skrll }
2719 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
2720 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
2721 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
2722 1.1 skrll {
2723 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
2724 1.1 skrll if (asect->size == 0
2725 1.1 skrll && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
2726 1.1 skrll {
2727 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
2728 1.1 skrll
2729 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2730 1.1 skrll if (o != NULL)
2731 1.1 skrll {
2732 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
2733 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
2734 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
2735 1.1 skrll }
2736 1.3 christos }
2737 1.3 christos }
2738 1.3 christos if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
2739 1.3 christos this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
2740 1.3 christos
2741 1.3 christos /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
2742 1.3 christos SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
2743 1.3 christos this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
2744 1.3 christos create the other. */
2745 1.3 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
2746 1.3 christos {
2747 1.3 christos /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
2748 1.3 christos needed. */
2749 1.3 christos if (arg->link_info
2750 1.3 christos /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
2751 1.3 christos && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
2752 1.3 christos && (arg->link_info->relocatable || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
2753 1.3 christos {
2754 1.3 christos if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
2755 1.3 christos && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, asect, FALSE))
2756 1.3 christos {
2757 1.3 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
2758 1.3 christos return;
2759 1.3 christos }
2760 1.3 christos if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
2761 1.3 christos && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, asect, TRUE))
2762 1.3 christos {
2763 1.3 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
2764 1.3 christos return;
2765 1.3 christos }
2766 1.3 christos }
2767 1.3 christos else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
2768 1.3 christos (asect->use_rela_p
2769 1.3 christos ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
2770 1.3 christos asect,
2771 1.3 christos asect->use_rela_p))
2772 1.1 skrll arg->failed = TRUE;
2773 1.1 skrll }
2774 1.1 skrll
2775 1.1 skrll /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
2776 1.1 skrll sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
2777 1.3 christos if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
2778 1.1 skrll && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
2779 1.1 skrll arg->failed = TRUE;
2780 1.1 skrll
2781 1.1 skrll if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
2782 1.1 skrll {
2783 1.1 skrll /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
2784 1.1 skrll called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
2785 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2786 1.1 skrll }
2787 1.2 skrll }
2788 1.2 skrll
2789 1.2 skrll /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
2790 1.2 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
2791 1.1 skrll when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
2792 1.1 skrll from bfd_elf_final_link. */
2793 1.1 skrll
2794 1.1 skrll void
2795 1.3 christos bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
2796 1.1 skrll {
2797 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
2798 1.1 skrll asection *elt, *first;
2799 1.1 skrll unsigned char *loc;
2800 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean gas;
2801 1.1 skrll
2802 1.1 skrll /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
2803 1.1 skrll elfxx-ia64.c. */
2804 1.1 skrll if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
2805 1.1 skrll || *failedptr)
2806 1.2 skrll return;
2807 1.2 skrll
2808 1.2 skrll if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
2809 1.2 skrll {
2810 1.2 skrll unsigned long symindx = 0;
2811 1.2 skrll
2812 1.2 skrll /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
2813 1.2 skrll generic linker. */
2814 1.2 skrll if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
2815 1.2 skrll symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
2816 1.2 skrll
2817 1.2 skrll if (symindx == 0)
2818 1.2 skrll {
2819 1.2 skrll /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
2820 1.2 skrll elf_section_syms. */
2821 1.2 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
2822 1.2 skrll symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
2823 1.2 skrll }
2824 1.2 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
2825 1.2 skrll }
2826 1.2 skrll else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
2827 1.2 skrll {
2828 1.2 skrll /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
2829 1.2 skrll signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
2830 1.2 skrll set until all local symbols are output. */
2831 1.2 skrll asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
2832 1.2 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
2833 1.2 skrll unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
2834 1.2 skrll unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
2835 1.2 skrll struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2836 1.2 skrll
2837 1.2 skrll if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
2838 1.2 skrll {
2839 1.2 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2840 1.2 skrll
2841 1.2 skrll symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
2842 1.2 skrll extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2843 1.2 skrll }
2844 1.2 skrll h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
2845 1.2 skrll while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2846 1.2 skrll || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2847 1.2 skrll h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2848 1.1 skrll
2849 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
2850 1.1 skrll }
2851 1.1 skrll
2852 1.1 skrll /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
2853 1.1 skrll gas = TRUE;
2854 1.1 skrll if (sec->contents == NULL)
2855 1.3 christos {
2856 1.1 skrll gas = FALSE;
2857 1.1 skrll sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
2858 1.1 skrll
2859 1.1 skrll /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
2860 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
2861 1.1 skrll if (sec->contents == NULL)
2862 1.1 skrll {
2863 1.1 skrll *failedptr = TRUE;
2864 1.1 skrll return;
2865 1.1 skrll }
2866 1.1 skrll }
2867 1.1 skrll
2868 1.1 skrll loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
2869 1.1 skrll
2870 1.1 skrll /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
2871 1.1 skrll squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
2872 1.1 skrll start of the input section group. */
2873 1.1 skrll first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
2874 1.1 skrll
2875 1.1 skrll /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
2876 1.1 skrll indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
2877 1.1 skrll just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
2878 1.1 skrll directives, not that it matters. */
2879 1.1 skrll while (elt != NULL)
2880 1.1 skrll {
2881 1.1 skrll asection *s;
2882 1.1 skrll
2883 1.1 skrll s = elt;
2884 1.3 christos if (!gas)
2885 1.3 christos s = s->output_section;
2886 1.3 christos if (s != NULL
2887 1.3 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
2888 1.3 christos {
2889 1.3 christos unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
2890 1.3 christos
2891 1.3 christos loc -= 4;
2892 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
2893 1.1 skrll }
2894 1.1 skrll elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
2895 1.1 skrll if (elt == first)
2896 1.1 skrll break;
2897 1.1 skrll }
2898 1.1 skrll
2899 1.1 skrll if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
2900 1.1 skrll abort ();
2901 1.1 skrll
2902 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
2903 1.1 skrll }
2904 1.1 skrll
2905 1.1 skrll /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
2906 1.1 skrll too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
2907 1.1 skrll in here too, while we're at it. */
2908 1.1 skrll
2909 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
2910 1.1 skrll assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
2911 1.1 skrll {
2912 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
2913 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
2914 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_number, secn;
2915 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
2916 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
2917 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean need_symtab;
2918 1.1 skrll
2919 1.1 skrll section_number = 1;
2920 1.1 skrll
2921 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
2922 1.1 skrll
2923 1.1 skrll /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
2924 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL || link_info->relocatable)
2925 1.1 skrll {
2926 1.1 skrll /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
2927 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2928 1.1 skrll {
2929 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
2930 1.1 skrll
2931 1.1 skrll if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
2932 1.1 skrll {
2933 1.1 skrll if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
2934 1.1 skrll {
2935 1.1 skrll /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
2936 1.1 skrll bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
2937 1.1 skrll abfd->section_count--;
2938 1.1 skrll }
2939 1.1 skrll else
2940 1.1 skrll d->this_idx = section_number++;
2941 1.1 skrll }
2942 1.1 skrll }
2943 1.1 skrll }
2944 1.1 skrll
2945 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
2946 1.1 skrll {
2947 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
2948 1.1 skrll
2949 1.1 skrll if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
2950 1.3 christos d->this_idx = section_number++;
2951 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
2952 1.3 christos if (d->rel.hdr)
2953 1.3 christos {
2954 1.1 skrll d->rel.idx = section_number++;
2955 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
2956 1.3 christos }
2957 1.1 skrll else
2958 1.3 christos d->rel.idx = 0;
2959 1.1 skrll
2960 1.3 christos if (d->rela.hdr)
2961 1.3 christos {
2962 1.1 skrll d->rela.idx = section_number++;
2963 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
2964 1.3 christos }
2965 1.1 skrll else
2966 1.1 skrll d->rela.idx = 0;
2967 1.1 skrll }
2968 1.1 skrll
2969 1.1 skrll t->shstrtab_section = section_number++;
2970 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
2971 1.3 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = t->shstrtab_section;
2972 1.3 christos
2973 1.3 christos need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
2974 1.3 christos || (link_info == NULL
2975 1.3 christos && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
2976 1.1 skrll == HAS_RELOC)));
2977 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
2978 1.1 skrll {
2979 1.1 skrll t->symtab_section = section_number++;
2980 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
2981 1.1 skrll if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
2982 1.1 skrll {
2983 1.1 skrll t->symtab_shndx_section = section_number++;
2984 1.1 skrll t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name
2985 1.1 skrll = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2986 1.1 skrll ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
2987 1.1 skrll if (t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2988 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2989 1.1 skrll }
2990 1.1 skrll t->strtab_section = section_number++;
2991 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
2992 1.1 skrll }
2993 1.1 skrll
2994 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
2995 1.1 skrll t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
2996 1.1 skrll
2997 1.1 skrll elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
2998 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
2999 1.1 skrll
3000 1.3 christos /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3001 1.3 christos indices. */
3002 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3003 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3004 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3005 1.3 christos return FALSE;
3006 1.3 christos
3007 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3008 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3009 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3010 1.1 skrll {
3011 1.1 skrll bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3012 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3013 1.1 skrll }
3014 1.1 skrll
3015 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3016 1.3 christos
3017 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[t->shstrtab_section] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3018 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
3019 1.1 skrll {
3020 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[t->symtab_section] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3021 1.1 skrll if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3022 1.1 skrll {
3023 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[t->symtab_shndx_section] = &t->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3024 1.1 skrll t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3025 1.1 skrll }
3026 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[t->strtab_section] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3027 1.1 skrll t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = t->strtab_section;
3028 1.1 skrll }
3029 1.1 skrll
3030 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3031 1.1 skrll {
3032 1.1 skrll asection *s;
3033 1.3 christos const char *name;
3034 1.3 christos
3035 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3036 1.3 christos
3037 1.3 christos i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3038 1.3 christos if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3039 1.3 christos i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3040 1.1 skrll if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3041 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3042 1.1 skrll
3043 1.1 skrll /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3044 1.1 skrll
3045 1.1 skrll /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3046 1.3 christos table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3047 1.1 skrll the relocation entries apply. */
3048 1.3 christos if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3049 1.3 christos {
3050 1.1 skrll d->rel.hdr->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3051 1.3 christos d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3052 1.1 skrll }
3053 1.3 christos if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3054 1.3 christos {
3055 1.1 skrll d->rela.hdr->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3056 1.1 skrll d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3057 1.1 skrll }
3058 1.1 skrll
3059 1.1 skrll /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3060 1.1 skrll if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3061 1.1 skrll {
3062 1.1 skrll s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3063 1.1 skrll if (s)
3064 1.1 skrll {
3065 1.1 skrll /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3066 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
3067 1.1 skrll {
3068 1.1 skrll /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3069 1.1 skrll if (elf_discarded_section (s))
3070 1.1 skrll {
3071 1.1 skrll asection *kept;
3072 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
3073 1.1 skrll (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3074 1.1 skrll abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3075 1.1 skrll s, s->owner);
3076 1.1 skrll /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3077 1.1 skrll size as the discarded one. */
3078 1.1 skrll kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3079 1.1 skrll if (kept == NULL)
3080 1.1 skrll {
3081 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3082 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3083 1.1 skrll }
3084 1.1 skrll s = kept;
3085 1.1 skrll }
3086 1.1 skrll
3087 1.1 skrll s = s->output_section;
3088 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3089 1.1 skrll }
3090 1.1 skrll else
3091 1.1 skrll {
3092 1.1 skrll /* Handle objcopy. */
3093 1.1 skrll if (s->output_section == NULL)
3094 1.1 skrll {
3095 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
3096 1.1 skrll (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3097 1.1 skrll abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3098 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3099 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3100 1.1 skrll }
3101 1.1 skrll s = s->output_section;
3102 1.1 skrll }
3103 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3104 1.1 skrll }
3105 1.1 skrll else
3106 1.1 skrll {
3107 1.1 skrll /* PR 290:
3108 1.1 skrll The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3109 1.1 skrll SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3110 1.1 skrll sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3111 1.1 skrll where s is NULL. */
3112 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3113 1.1 skrll = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3114 1.1 skrll if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3115 1.1 skrll bed->link_order_error_handler
3116 1.1 skrll (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3117 1.1 skrll abfd, sec);
3118 1.1 skrll }
3119 1.1 skrll }
3120 1.1 skrll
3121 1.1 skrll switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3122 1.1 skrll {
3123 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
3124 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
3125 1.1 skrll /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3126 1.1 skrll section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3127 1.1 skrll table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3128 1.1 skrll which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3129 1.1 skrll allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3130 1.1 skrll FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3131 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3132 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3133 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3134 1.1 skrll
3135 1.1 skrll /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3136 1.1 skrll name = sec->name;
3137 1.1 skrll if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL)
3138 1.1 skrll name += 4;
3139 1.1 skrll else
3140 1.1 skrll name += 5;
3141 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3142 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3143 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3144 1.1 skrll break;
3145 1.1 skrll
3146 1.1 skrll case SHT_STRTAB:
3147 1.1 skrll /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3148 1.1 skrll string section. We look for a section with the same name
3149 1.1 skrll but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3150 1.1 skrll field to point to this section. */
3151 1.1 skrll if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3152 1.1 skrll && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3153 1.1 skrll {
3154 1.1 skrll size_t len;
3155 1.1 skrll char *alc;
3156 1.3 christos
3157 1.1 skrll len = strlen (sec->name);
3158 1.1 skrll alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3159 1.1 skrll if (alc == NULL)
3160 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3161 1.1 skrll memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3162 1.1 skrll alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3163 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3164 1.1 skrll free (alc);
3165 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3166 1.1 skrll {
3167 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3168 1.1 skrll
3169 1.1 skrll /* This is a .stab section. */
3170 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3171 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3172 1.1 skrll = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3173 1.1 skrll }
3174 1.1 skrll }
3175 1.1 skrll break;
3176 1.1 skrll
3177 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3178 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM:
3179 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3180 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3181 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3182 1.1 skrll used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3183 1.1 skrll version strings. */
3184 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3185 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3186 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3187 1.1 skrll break;
3188 1.1 skrll
3189 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3190 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3191 1.1 skrll list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3192 1.1 skrll the version strings. */
3193 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3194 1.1 skrll ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3195 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3196 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3197 1.1 skrll break;
3198 1.1 skrll
3199 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH:
3200 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3201 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
3202 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3203 1.1 skrll this hash table or version table is for. */
3204 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3205 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3206 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3207 1.1 skrll break;
3208 1.1 skrll
3209 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
3210 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3211 1.1 skrll }
3212 1.1 skrll }
3213 1.1 skrll
3214 1.1 skrll for (secn = 1; secn < section_number; ++secn)
3215 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[secn] == NULL)
3216 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[secn] = i_shdrp[0];
3217 1.1 skrll else
3218 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3219 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name);
3220 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3221 1.1 skrll }
3222 1.1 skrll
3223 1.1 skrll /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3224 1.1 skrll all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
3225 1.1 skrll
3226 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3227 1.1 skrll sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3228 1.1 skrll {
3229 1.1 skrll /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3230 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3231 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3232 1.3 christos return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3233 1.1 skrll
3234 1.1 skrll return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3235 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3236 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3237 1.1 skrll }
3238 1.1 skrll
3239 1.1 skrll /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3240 1.1 skrll output. */
3241 1.1 skrll
3242 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3243 1.1 skrll ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3244 1.1 skrll {
3245 1.1 skrll return ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3246 1.1 skrll && !(sym->section->owner == abfd
3247 1.1 skrll || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
3248 1.1 skrll && sym->section->output_offset == 0)));
3249 1.1 skrll }
3250 1.1 skrll
3251 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3252 1.1 skrll elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd)
3253 1.1 skrll {
3254 1.1 skrll unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3255 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3256 1.1 skrll asymbol **sect_syms;
3257 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_locals = 0;
3258 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_globals = 0;
3259 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
3260 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
3261 1.1 skrll int max_index = 0;
3262 1.1 skrll unsigned int idx;
3263 1.1 skrll asection *asect;
3264 1.1 skrll asymbol **new_syms;
3265 1.1 skrll
3266 1.1 skrll #ifdef DEBUG
3267 1.1 skrll fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
3268 1.1 skrll fflush (stderr);
3269 1.1 skrll #endif
3270 1.1 skrll
3271 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3272 1.1 skrll {
3273 1.1 skrll if (max_index < asect->index)
3274 1.1 skrll max_index = asect->index;
3275 1.1 skrll }
3276 1.3 christos
3277 1.1 skrll max_index++;
3278 1.1 skrll sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
3279 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms == NULL)
3280 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3281 1.1 skrll elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
3282 1.1 skrll elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
3283 1.1 skrll
3284 1.1 skrll /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
3285 1.1 skrll decided to output. */
3286 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3287 1.1 skrll {
3288 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3289 1.1 skrll
3290 1.1 skrll if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3291 1.1 skrll && sym->value == 0
3292 1.1 skrll && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3293 1.1 skrll {
3294 1.1 skrll asection *sec = sym->section;
3295 1.1 skrll
3296 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner != abfd)
3297 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
3298 1.1 skrll
3299 1.1 skrll sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
3300 1.1 skrll }
3301 1.1 skrll }
3302 1.1 skrll
3303 1.1 skrll /* Classify all of the symbols. */
3304 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3305 1.1 skrll {
3306 1.1 skrll if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
3307 1.1 skrll continue;
3308 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
3309 1.1 skrll num_locals++;
3310 1.1 skrll else
3311 1.1 skrll num_globals++;
3312 1.1 skrll }
3313 1.1 skrll
3314 1.1 skrll /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
3315 1.1 skrll sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
3316 1.1 skrll eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
3317 1.1 skrll at least in that case. */
3318 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3319 1.1 skrll {
3320 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3321 1.1 skrll {
3322 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
3323 1.1 skrll num_locals++;
3324 1.1 skrll else
3325 1.1 skrll num_globals++;
3326 1.1 skrll }
3327 1.1 skrll }
3328 1.3 christos
3329 1.3 christos /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
3330 1.1 skrll new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
3331 1.1 skrll sizeof (asymbol *));
3332 1.1 skrll
3333 1.1 skrll if (new_syms == NULL)
3334 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3335 1.1 skrll
3336 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3337 1.1 skrll {
3338 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3339 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
3340 1.1 skrll
3341 1.1 skrll if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3342 1.1 skrll continue;
3343 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3344 1.1 skrll i = num_locals2++;
3345 1.1 skrll else
3346 1.1 skrll i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3347 1.1 skrll new_syms[i] = sym;
3348 1.1 skrll sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3349 1.1 skrll }
3350 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3351 1.1 skrll {
3352 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3353 1.1 skrll {
3354 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
3355 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
3356 1.1 skrll
3357 1.1 skrll sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
3358 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3359 1.1 skrll i = num_locals2++;
3360 1.1 skrll else
3361 1.1 skrll i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3362 1.1 skrll new_syms[i] = sym;
3363 1.1 skrll sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3364 1.1 skrll }
3365 1.1 skrll }
3366 1.1 skrll
3367 1.1 skrll bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
3368 1.1 skrll
3369 1.1 skrll elf_num_locals (abfd) = num_locals;
3370 1.1 skrll elf_num_globals (abfd) = num_globals;
3371 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3372 1.1 skrll }
3373 1.1 skrll
3374 1.1 skrll /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
3375 1.1 skrll ELF data structure. */
3376 1.1 skrll
3377 1.1 skrll static inline file_ptr
3378 1.1 skrll align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
3379 1.1 skrll {
3380 1.1 skrll return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
3381 1.1 skrll }
3382 1.1 skrll
3383 1.1 skrll /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
3384 1.1 skrll required section alignment. */
3385 1.1 skrll
3386 1.1 skrll file_ptr
3387 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
3388 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset,
3389 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean align)
3390 1.1 skrll {
3391 1.1 skrll if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
3392 1.1 skrll offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
3393 1.1 skrll i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
3394 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
3395 1.1 skrll i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
3396 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
3397 1.1 skrll offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
3398 1.1 skrll return offset;
3399 1.1 skrll }
3400 1.1 skrll
3401 1.1 skrll /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
3402 1.1 skrll otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
3403 1.1 skrll is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
3404 1.1 skrll
3405 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
3406 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
3407 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3408 1.3 christos {
3409 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3410 1.1 skrll struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
3411 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean failed;
3412 1.3 christos struct bfd_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
3413 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
3414 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3415 1.1 skrll
3416 1.1 skrll if (abfd->output_has_begun)
3417 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3418 1.1 skrll
3419 1.1 skrll /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
3420 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
3421 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
3422 1.1 skrll
3423 1.1 skrll if (! prep_headers (abfd))
3424 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3425 1.1 skrll
3426 1.1 skrll /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
3427 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers)
3428 1.3 christos (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
3429 1.3 christos
3430 1.3 christos fsargs.failed = FALSE;
3431 1.3 christos fsargs.link_info = link_info;
3432 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
3433 1.1 skrll if (fsargs.failed)
3434 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3435 1.1 skrll
3436 1.1 skrll if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
3437 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3438 1.3 christos
3439 1.3 christos /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
3440 1.3 christos need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
3441 1.3 christos && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3442 1.3 christos || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3443 1.1 skrll == HAS_RELOC)));
3444 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
3445 1.1 skrll {
3446 1.1 skrll /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
3447 1.1 skrll int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
3448 1.1 skrll
3449 1.1 skrll if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
3450 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3451 1.3 christos }
3452 1.1 skrll
3453 1.1 skrll failed = FALSE;
3454 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL)
3455 1.1 skrll {
3456 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
3457 1.1 skrll if (failed)
3458 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3459 1.1 skrll }
3460 1.1 skrll
3461 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
3462 1.1 skrll /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
3463 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
3464 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3465 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3466 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3467 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3468 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3469 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
3470 1.1 skrll /* sh_offset is set in assign_file_positions_except_relocs. */
3471 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
3472 1.1 skrll
3473 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
3474 1.3 christos return FALSE;
3475 1.1 skrll
3476 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
3477 1.1 skrll {
3478 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
3479 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
3480 1.1 skrll
3481 1.1 skrll off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
3482 1.1 skrll
3483 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
3484 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3485 1.1 skrll
3486 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3487 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
3488 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3489 1.1 skrll
3490 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
3491 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3492 1.1 skrll
3493 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
3494 1.1 skrll
3495 1.1 skrll /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
3496 1.1 skrll out. */
3497 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
3498 1.1 skrll || ! _bfd_stringtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
3499 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3500 1.1 skrll _bfd_stringtab_free (strtab);
3501 1.1 skrll }
3502 1.1 skrll
3503 1.1 skrll abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
3504 1.1 skrll
3505 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3506 1.1 skrll }
3507 1.1 skrll
3508 1.1 skrll /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
3509 1.1 skrll get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
3510 1.1 skrll
3511 1.1 skrll static bfd_size_type
3512 1.1 skrll get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3513 1.1 skrll {
3514 1.1 skrll size_t segs;
3515 1.1 skrll asection *s;
3516 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3517 1.1 skrll
3518 1.1 skrll /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
3519 1.1 skrll and one for data. */
3520 1.1 skrll segs = 2;
3521 1.1 skrll
3522 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3523 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3524 1.1 skrll {
3525 1.1 skrll /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
3526 1.1 skrll PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
3527 1.1 skrll PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
3528 1.1 skrll targets. */
3529 1.1 skrll segs += 2;
3530 1.1 skrll }
3531 1.1 skrll
3532 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
3533 1.1 skrll {
3534 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
3535 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3536 1.1 skrll }
3537 1.1 skrll
3538 1.1 skrll if (info != NULL && info->relro)
3539 1.1 skrll {
3540 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
3541 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3542 1.1 skrll }
3543 1.1 skrll
3544 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr)
3545 1.1 skrll {
3546 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
3547 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3548 1.1 skrll }
3549 1.1 skrll
3550 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
3551 1.1 skrll {
3552 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
3553 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3554 1.1 skrll }
3555 1.1 skrll
3556 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3557 1.1 skrll {
3558 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3559 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
3560 1.1 skrll {
3561 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
3562 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3563 1.1 skrll /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
3564 1.1 skrll for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
3565 1.1 skrll gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
3566 1.1 skrll (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
3567 1.1 skrll each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
3568 1.1 skrll so we check whether the sections are correctly
3569 1.1 skrll aligned. */
3570 1.1 skrll if (s->alignment_power == 2)
3571 1.1 skrll while (s->next != NULL
3572 1.1 skrll && s->next->alignment_power == 2
3573 1.1 skrll && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3574 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
3575 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
3576 1.1 skrll }
3577 1.1 skrll }
3578 1.1 skrll
3579 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3580 1.1 skrll {
3581 1.1 skrll if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3582 1.1 skrll {
3583 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
3584 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3585 1.1 skrll break;
3586 1.1 skrll }
3587 1.1 skrll }
3588 1.1 skrll
3589 1.1 skrll /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
3590 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3591 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
3592 1.1 skrll {
3593 1.1 skrll int a;
3594 1.1 skrll
3595 1.1 skrll a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
3596 1.1 skrll if (a == -1)
3597 1.1 skrll abort ();
3598 1.1 skrll segs += a;
3599 1.1 skrll }
3600 1.1 skrll
3601 1.1 skrll return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
3602 1.1 skrll }
3603 1.1 skrll
3604 1.1 skrll /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
3605 1.1 skrll
3606 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *
3607 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
3608 1.1 skrll {
3609 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
3610 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
3611 1.1 skrll
3612 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map,
3613 1.1 skrll p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
3614 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
3615 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++)
3616 1.1 skrll {
3617 1.1 skrll int i;
3618 1.1 skrll
3619 1.1 skrll for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3620 1.1 skrll if (m->sections[i] == section)
3621 1.1 skrll return p;
3622 1.1 skrll }
3623 1.1 skrll
3624 1.1 skrll return NULL;
3625 1.1 skrll }
3626 1.1 skrll
3627 1.1 skrll /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
3628 1.1 skrll
3629 1.1 skrll static struct elf_segment_map *
3630 1.1 skrll make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
3631 1.1 skrll asection **sections,
3632 1.1 skrll unsigned int from,
3633 1.1 skrll unsigned int to,
3634 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr)
3635 1.1 skrll {
3636 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
3637 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
3638 1.1 skrll asection **hdrpp;
3639 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
3640 1.1 skrll
3641 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3642 1.1 skrll amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
3643 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3644 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
3645 1.1 skrll return NULL;
3646 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
3647 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
3648 1.1 skrll for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
3649 1.1 skrll m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
3650 1.1 skrll m->count = to - from;
3651 1.1 skrll
3652 1.1 skrll if (from == 0 && phdr)
3653 1.1 skrll {
3654 1.1 skrll /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
3655 1.1 skrll m->includes_filehdr = 1;
3656 1.1 skrll m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3657 1.1 skrll }
3658 1.1 skrll
3659 1.1 skrll return m;
3660 1.1 skrll }
3661 1.1 skrll
3662 1.1 skrll /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
3663 1.1 skrll on failure. */
3664 1.1 skrll
3665 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *
3666 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
3667 1.1 skrll {
3668 1.3 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
3669 1.3 christos
3670 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3671 1.1 skrll sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
3672 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
3673 1.1 skrll return NULL;
3674 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
3675 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
3676 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
3677 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = dynsec;
3678 1.1 skrll
3679 1.1 skrll return m;
3680 1.1 skrll }
3681 1.1 skrll
3682 1.1 skrll /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
3683 1.1 skrll
3684 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3685 1.1 skrll elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
3686 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *info,
3687 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
3688 1.1 skrll {
3689 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **m;
3690 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3691 1.1 skrll
3692 1.1 skrll /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
3693 1.1 skrll not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
3694 1.1 skrll sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
3695 1.1 skrll sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
3696 1.1 skrll removed. */
3697 1.1 skrll m = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
3698 1.1 skrll while (*m)
3699 1.1 skrll {
3700 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, new_count;
3701 1.1 skrll
3702 1.1 skrll for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
3703 1.1 skrll {
3704 1.1 skrll if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3705 1.1 skrll && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3706 1.1 skrll || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
3707 1.1 skrll {
3708 1.1 skrll (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
3709 1.1 skrll new_count++;
3710 1.1 skrll }
3711 1.1 skrll }
3712 1.1 skrll (*m)->count = new_count;
3713 1.1 skrll
3714 1.1 skrll if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
3715 1.1 skrll *m = (*m)->next;
3716 1.1 skrll else
3717 1.1 skrll m = &(*m)->next;
3718 1.1 skrll }
3719 1.1 skrll
3720 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3721 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
3722 1.1 skrll {
3723 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
3724 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3725 1.1 skrll }
3726 1.1 skrll
3727 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3728 1.1 skrll }
3729 1.1 skrll
3730 1.1 skrll /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
3731 1.1 skrll
3732 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
3733 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3734 1.1 skrll {
3735 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
3736 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
3737 1.1 skrll asection **sections = NULL;
3738 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3739 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
3740 1.1 skrll
3741 1.1 skrll no_user_phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map == NULL;
3742 1.1 skrll if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
3743 1.1 skrll {
3744 1.1 skrll asection *s;
3745 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
3746 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
3747 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pm;
3748 1.1 skrll asection *last_hdr;
3749 1.1 skrll bfd_vma last_size;
3750 1.1 skrll unsigned int phdr_index;
3751 1.1 skrll bfd_vma maxpagesize;
3752 1.1 skrll asection **hdrpp;
3753 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
3754 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean writable;
3755 1.1 skrll int tls_count = 0;
3756 1.1 skrll asection *first_tls = NULL;
3757 1.3 christos asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
3758 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
3759 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
3760 1.1 skrll
3761 1.3 christos /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
3762 1.3 christos
3763 1.1 skrll sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
3764 1.1 skrll sizeof (asection *));
3765 1.1 skrll if (sections == NULL)
3766 1.3 christos goto error_return;
3767 1.3 christos
3768 1.3 christos /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
3769 1.3 christos left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
3770 1.3 christos being shifted. */
3771 1.3 christos addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
3772 1.1 skrll addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
3773 1.1 skrll
3774 1.1 skrll i = 0;
3775 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3776 1.1 skrll {
3777 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3778 1.1 skrll {
3779 1.3 christos sections[i] = s;
3780 1.3 christos ++i;
3781 1.3 christos /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
3782 1.1 skrll if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
3783 1.1 skrll wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
3784 1.1 skrll }
3785 1.1 skrll }
3786 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
3787 1.1 skrll count = i;
3788 1.1 skrll
3789 1.1 skrll qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
3790 1.1 skrll
3791 1.1 skrll /* Build the mapping. */
3792 1.1 skrll
3793 1.1 skrll mfirst = NULL;
3794 1.1 skrll pm = &mfirst;
3795 1.1 skrll
3796 1.1 skrll /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
3797 1.1 skrll the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
3798 1.1 skrll section. */
3799 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3800 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3801 1.3 christos {
3802 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3803 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3804 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
3805 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
3806 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
3807 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
3808 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not. */
3809 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
3810 1.1 skrll m->p_flags_valid = 1;
3811 1.1 skrll m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3812 1.1 skrll
3813 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
3814 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
3815 1.3 christos
3816 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3817 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3818 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
3819 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
3820 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
3821 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
3822 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
3823 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = s;
3824 1.1 skrll
3825 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
3826 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
3827 1.1 skrll }
3828 1.1 skrll
3829 1.1 skrll /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
3830 1.1 skrll segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
3831 1.1 skrll a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
3832 1.1 skrll last_hdr = NULL;
3833 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
3834 1.1 skrll phdr_index = 0;
3835 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
3836 1.1 skrll writable = FALSE;
3837 1.1 skrll dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
3838 1.1 skrll if (dynsec != NULL
3839 1.1 skrll && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
3840 1.1 skrll dynsec = NULL;
3841 1.1 skrll
3842 1.1 skrll /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
3843 1.1 skrll is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
3844 1.1 skrll approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
3845 1.1 skrll program headers we will need. */
3846 1.1 skrll if (count > 0)
3847 1.1 skrll {
3848 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
3849 1.1 skrll
3850 1.1 skrll if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
3851 1.3 christos phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
3852 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
3853 1.3 christos || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
3854 1.3 christos || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
3855 1.1 skrll < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
3856 1.1 skrll || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
3857 1.1 skrll phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
3858 1.1 skrll }
3859 1.1 skrll
3860 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
3861 1.1 skrll {
3862 1.1 skrll asection *hdr;
3863 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean new_segment;
3864 1.1 skrll
3865 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
3866 1.1 skrll
3867 1.1 skrll /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
3868 1.1 skrll segment. */
3869 1.1 skrll
3870 1.1 skrll if (last_hdr == NULL)
3871 1.1 skrll {
3872 1.1 skrll /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
3873 1.1 skrll one (we build the last one after this loop). */
3874 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
3875 1.1 skrll }
3876 1.1 skrll else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
3877 1.1 skrll {
3878 1.1 skrll /* If this section has a different relation between the
3879 1.1 skrll virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
3880 1.1 skrll segment. */
3881 1.3 christos new_segment = TRUE;
3882 1.3 christos }
3883 1.3 christos else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
3884 1.3 christos || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
3885 1.3 christos {
3886 1.3 christos /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
3887 1.3 christos the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
3888 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
3889 1.1 skrll }
3890 1.1 skrll /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
3891 1.1 skrll to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
3892 1.1 skrll around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
3893 1.1 skrll pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
3894 1.1 skrll section can be included in the current segment. */
3895 1.1 skrll else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
3896 1.1 skrll > last_hdr->lma)
3897 1.1 skrll && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
3898 1.1 skrll <= hdr->lma))
3899 1.1 skrll {
3900 1.1 skrll /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
3901 1.1 skrll skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
3902 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
3903 1.1 skrll }
3904 1.1 skrll else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
3905 1.1 skrll && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
3906 1.1 skrll {
3907 1.1 skrll /* We don't want to put a loadable section after a
3908 1.1 skrll nonloadable section in the same segment.
3909 1.1 skrll Consider .tbss sections as loadable for this purpose. */
3910 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
3911 1.1 skrll }
3912 1.1 skrll else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
3913 1.1 skrll {
3914 1.1 skrll /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
3915 1.1 skrll don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
3916 1.1 skrll file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
3917 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
3918 1.1 skrll }
3919 1.3 christos else if (! writable
3920 1.3 christos && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
3921 1.1 skrll && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
3922 1.1 skrll != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
3923 1.1 skrll {
3924 1.1 skrll /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
3925 1.1 skrll segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
3926 1.1 skrll anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
3927 1.1 skrll bring us past the current section on the page, so the
3928 1.1 skrll only case in which the new section is not on the same
3929 1.1 skrll page as the previous section is when the previous section
3930 1.1 skrll ends precisely on a page boundary. */
3931 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
3932 1.1 skrll }
3933 1.1 skrll else
3934 1.1 skrll {
3935 1.1 skrll /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
3936 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
3937 1.1 skrll }
3938 1.1 skrll
3939 1.1 skrll /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
3940 1.1 skrll if (last_hdr != NULL
3941 1.1 skrll && info != NULL
3942 1.1 skrll && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
3943 1.1 skrll new_segment
3944 1.1 skrll = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
3945 1.1 skrll last_hdr,
3946 1.1 skrll new_segment);
3947 1.1 skrll
3948 1.1 skrll if (! new_segment)
3949 1.1 skrll {
3950 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3951 1.1 skrll writable = TRUE;
3952 1.1 skrll last_hdr = hdr;
3953 1.1 skrll /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
3954 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
3955 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3956 1.1 skrll last_size = hdr->size;
3957 1.1 skrll else
3958 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
3959 1.1 skrll continue;
3960 1.1 skrll }
3961 1.1 skrll
3962 1.1 skrll /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
3963 1.1 skrll header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
3964 1.1 skrll
3965 1.1 skrll m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
3966 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
3967 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
3968 1.1 skrll
3969 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
3970 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
3971 1.1 skrll
3972 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3973 1.1 skrll writable = TRUE;
3974 1.1 skrll else
3975 1.1 skrll writable = FALSE;
3976 1.1 skrll
3977 1.1 skrll last_hdr = hdr;
3978 1.1 skrll /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
3979 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3980 1.1 skrll last_size = hdr->size;
3981 1.1 skrll else
3982 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
3983 1.1 skrll phdr_index = i;
3984 1.1 skrll phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
3985 1.3 christos }
3986 1.3 christos
3987 1.3 christos /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
3988 1.3 christos for .tbss. */
3989 1.3 christos if (last_hdr != NULL
3990 1.3 christos && (i - phdr_index != 1
3991 1.1 skrll || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
3992 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
3993 1.1 skrll {
3994 1.1 skrll m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
3995 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
3996 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
3997 1.1 skrll
3998 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
3999 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4000 1.1 skrll }
4001 1.1 skrll
4002 1.1 skrll /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4003 1.1 skrll if (dynsec != NULL)
4004 1.1 skrll {
4005 1.1 skrll m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4006 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4007 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4008 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4009 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4010 1.1 skrll }
4011 1.1 skrll
4012 1.1 skrll /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4013 1.1 skrll add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4014 1.1 skrll because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4015 1.1 skrll loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4016 1.1 skrll in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4017 1.1 skrll bogus anyhow. */
4018 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4019 1.1 skrll {
4020 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4021 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4022 1.3 christos {
4023 1.3 christos asection *s2;
4024 1.1 skrll
4025 1.1 skrll count = 1;
4026 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4027 1.1 skrll if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4028 1.1 skrll for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4029 1.1 skrll {
4030 1.1 skrll if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4031 1.3 christos && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4032 1.3 christos && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4033 1.1 skrll && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4034 1.1 skrll == s2->next->lma)
4035 1.1 skrll count++;
4036 1.1 skrll else
4037 1.1 skrll break;
4038 1.3 christos }
4039 1.1 skrll amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4040 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4041 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4042 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4043 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4044 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4045 1.1 skrll m->count = count;
4046 1.1 skrll while (count > 1)
4047 1.1 skrll {
4048 1.1 skrll m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4049 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4050 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4051 1.1 skrll }
4052 1.1 skrll m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4053 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4054 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4055 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4056 1.1 skrll }
4057 1.1 skrll if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4058 1.1 skrll {
4059 1.1 skrll if (! tls_count)
4060 1.1 skrll first_tls = s;
4061 1.1 skrll tls_count++;
4062 1.1 skrll }
4063 1.1 skrll }
4064 1.1 skrll
4065 1.1 skrll /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4066 1.1 skrll if (tls_count > 0)
4067 1.1 skrll {
4068 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4069 1.1 skrll amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4070 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4071 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4072 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4073 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4074 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4075 1.1 skrll m->count = tls_count;
4076 1.1 skrll /* Mandated PF_R. */
4077 1.3 christos m->p_flags = PF_R;
4078 1.1 skrll m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4079 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4080 1.1 skrll {
4081 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (first_tls->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL);
4082 1.1 skrll m->sections[i] = first_tls;
4083 1.1 skrll first_tls = first_tls->next;
4084 1.1 skrll }
4085 1.1 skrll
4086 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4087 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4088 1.1 skrll }
4089 1.1 skrll
4090 1.1 skrll /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4091 1.1 skrll segment. */
4092 1.1 skrll eh_frame_hdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr;
4093 1.1 skrll if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4094 1.1 skrll && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4095 1.3 christos {
4096 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4097 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4098 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4099 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4100 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4101 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4102 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
4103 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4104 1.1 skrll
4105 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4106 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4107 1.1 skrll }
4108 1.1 skrll
4109 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
4110 1.3 christos {
4111 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4112 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4113 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4114 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4115 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4116 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4117 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags;
4118 1.1 skrll m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4119 1.1 skrll
4120 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4121 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4122 1.1 skrll }
4123 1.1 skrll
4124 1.1 skrll if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4125 1.1 skrll {
4126 1.1 skrll for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4127 1.1 skrll {
4128 1.1 skrll if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD)
4129 1.1 skrll {
4130 1.1 skrll asection *last = m->sections[m->count - 1];
4131 1.1 skrll bfd_vma vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma;
4132 1.1 skrll bfd_vma filesz = last->vma - vaddr + last->size;
4133 1.1 skrll
4134 1.1 skrll if (vaddr < info->relro_end
4135 1.1 skrll && vaddr >= info->relro_start
4136 1.1 skrll && (vaddr + filesz) >= info->relro_end)
4137 1.1 skrll break;
4138 1.1 skrll }
4139 1.1 skrll }
4140 1.1 skrll
4141 1.1 skrll /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
4142 1.1 skrll if (m != NULL)
4143 1.3 christos {
4144 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4145 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4146 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4147 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4148 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4149 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
4150 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = PF_R;
4151 1.1 skrll m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4152 1.1 skrll
4153 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4154 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4155 1.1 skrll }
4156 1.1 skrll }
4157 1.1 skrll
4158 1.1 skrll free (sections);
4159 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map = mfirst;
4160 1.1 skrll }
4161 1.1 skrll
4162 1.1 skrll if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
4163 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4164 1.1 skrll
4165 1.1 skrll for (count = 0, m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4166 1.1 skrll ++count;
4167 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4168 1.1 skrll
4169 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4170 1.1 skrll
4171 1.1 skrll error_return:
4172 1.1 skrll if (sections != NULL)
4173 1.1 skrll free (sections);
4174 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4175 1.1 skrll }
4176 1.1 skrll
4177 1.1 skrll /* Sort sections by address. */
4178 1.1 skrll
4179 1.1 skrll static int
4180 1.1 skrll elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
4181 1.1 skrll {
4182 1.1 skrll const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
4183 1.1 skrll const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
4184 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type size1, size2;
4185 1.1 skrll
4186 1.1 skrll /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
4187 1.1 skrll place the section into a segment. */
4188 1.1 skrll if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
4189 1.1 skrll return -1;
4190 1.1 skrll else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
4191 1.1 skrll return 1;
4192 1.1 skrll
4193 1.1 skrll /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
4194 1.1 skrll the same, and this will do nothing. */
4195 1.1 skrll if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
4196 1.1 skrll return -1;
4197 1.1 skrll else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
4198 1.1 skrll return 1;
4199 1.1 skrll
4200 1.1 skrll /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
4201 1.1 skrll
4202 1.1 skrll #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
4203 1.1 skrll
4204 1.1 skrll if (TOEND (sec1))
4205 1.1 skrll {
4206 1.1 skrll if (TOEND (sec2))
4207 1.1 skrll {
4208 1.1 skrll /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
4209 1.1 skrll here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
4210 1.1 skrll if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
4211 1.1 skrll return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4212 1.1 skrll }
4213 1.1 skrll else
4214 1.1 skrll return 1;
4215 1.1 skrll }
4216 1.1 skrll else if (TOEND (sec2))
4217 1.1 skrll return -1;
4218 1.1 skrll
4219 1.1 skrll #undef TOEND
4220 1.1 skrll
4221 1.1 skrll /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
4222 1.1 skrll before others at the same address. */
4223 1.1 skrll
4224 1.1 skrll size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
4225 1.1 skrll size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
4226 1.1 skrll
4227 1.1 skrll if (size1 < size2)
4228 1.1 skrll return -1;
4229 1.1 skrll if (size1 > size2)
4230 1.1 skrll return 1;
4231 1.1 skrll
4232 1.1 skrll return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4233 1.1 skrll }
4234 1.1 skrll
4235 1.1 skrll /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
4236 1.1 skrll
4237 1.1 skrll We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
4238 1.1 skrll not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
4239 1.1 skrll negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
4240 1.1 skrll are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
4241 1.1 skrll larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
4242 1.1 skrll which is wrong.
4243 1.1 skrll
4244 1.1 skrll What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
4245 1.1 skrll the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
4246 1.1 skrll the page size.'' */
4247 1.1 skrll /* In other words, something like:
4248 1.1 skrll
4249 1.1 skrll vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
4250 1.1 skrll off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
4251 1.1 skrll if (vma_offset < off_offset)
4252 1.1 skrll adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
4253 1.1 skrll else
4254 1.1 skrll adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
4255 1.1 skrll
4256 1.1 skrll which can can be collapsed into the expression below. */
4257 1.1 skrll
4258 1.1 skrll static file_ptr
4259 1.1 skrll vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
4260 1.1 skrll {
4261 1.1 skrll return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
4262 1.1 skrll }
4263 1.1 skrll
4264 1.1 skrll static void
4265 1.1 skrll print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
4266 1.1 skrll {
4267 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
4268 1.1 skrll const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
4269 1.1 skrll char buf[32];
4270 1.1 skrll
4271 1.1 skrll if (pt == NULL)
4272 1.1 skrll {
4273 1.1 skrll if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
4274 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
4275 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
4276 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
4277 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
4278 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
4279 1.1 skrll else
4280 1.1 skrll snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
4281 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) m->p_type);
4282 1.3 christos pt = buf;
4283 1.1 skrll }
4284 1.1 skrll fflush (stdout);
4285 1.1 skrll fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
4286 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
4287 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
4288 1.3 christos putc ('\n',stderr);
4289 1.3 christos fflush (stderr);
4290 1.3 christos }
4291 1.3 christos
4292 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
4293 1.3 christos write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
4294 1.3 christos {
4295 1.3 christos void *buf;
4296 1.3 christos bfd_boolean ret;
4297 1.3 christos
4298 1.3 christos if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
4299 1.3 christos return FALSE;
4300 1.3 christos buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
4301 1.3 christos if (buf == NULL)
4302 1.3 christos return FALSE;
4303 1.3 christos ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
4304 1.1 skrll free (buf);
4305 1.1 skrll return ret;
4306 1.1 skrll }
4307 1.1 skrll
4308 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
4309 1.1 skrll sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
4310 1.1 skrll the file header. */
4311 1.1 skrll
4312 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4313 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4314 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4315 1.1 skrll {
4316 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4317 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4318 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4319 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4320 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
4321 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
4322 1.2 skrll unsigned int alloc;
4323 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, j;
4324 1.1 skrll bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
4325 1.1 skrll
4326 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL
4327 1.1 skrll && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
4328 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4329 1.1 skrll
4330 1.2 skrll alloc = 0;
4331 1.2 skrll for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4332 1.2 skrll {
4333 1.2 skrll ++alloc;
4334 1.2 skrll if (m->header_size)
4335 1.1 skrll header_pad = m->header_size;
4336 1.1 skrll }
4337 1.1 skrll
4338 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4339 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4340 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
4341 1.1 skrll
4342 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4343 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4344 1.1 skrll else
4345 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size
4346 1.1 skrll >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
4347 1.1 skrll
4348 1.1 skrll if (alloc == 0)
4349 1.1 skrll {
4350 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4351 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4352 1.2 skrll }
4353 1.2 skrll
4354 1.2 skrll /* We're writing the size in elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size,
4355 1.2 skrll see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
4356 1.2 skrll that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
4357 1.2 skrll The variable alloc contains the computed need, while elf_tdata
4358 1.2 skrll (abfd)->program_header_size contains the size used for the
4359 1.2 skrll layout.
4360 1.2 skrll See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
4361 1.2 skrll where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
4362 1.2 skrll last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
4363 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
4364 1.3 christos == 0);
4365 1.3 christos phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
4366 1.3 christos bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
4367 1.1 skrll (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
4368 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
4369 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
4370 1.1 skrll if (phdrs == NULL)
4371 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4372 1.1 skrll
4373 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = 1;
4374 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4375 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4376 1.1 skrll
4377 1.2 skrll off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4378 1.2 skrll off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4379 1.2 skrll if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
4380 1.2 skrll header_pad = 0;
4381 1.2 skrll else
4382 1.1 skrll header_pad -= off;
4383 1.1 skrll off += header_pad;
4384 1.1 skrll
4385 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs, j = 0;
4386 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
4387 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++, j++)
4388 1.1 skrll {
4389 1.1 skrll asection **secpp;
4390 1.1 skrll bfd_vma off_adjust;
4391 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean no_contents;
4392 1.1 skrll
4393 1.1 skrll /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
4394 1.1 skrll sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
4395 1.1 skrll not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
4396 1.1 skrll contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
4397 1.1 skrll Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
4398 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 1
4399 1.1 skrll && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
4400 1.1 skrll && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
4401 1.1 skrll qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
4402 1.1 skrll elf_sort_sections);
4403 1.1 skrll
4404 1.1 skrll /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
4405 1.1 skrll number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
4406 1.1 skrll and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
4407 1.1 skrll that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
4408 1.1 skrll available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
4409 1.1 skrll p->p_type = m->p_type;
4410 1.1 skrll p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
4411 1.1 skrll
4412 1.1 skrll if (m->count == 0)
4413 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = 0;
4414 1.1 skrll else
4415 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4416 1.1 skrll
4417 1.1 skrll if (m->p_paddr_valid)
4418 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
4419 1.1 skrll else if (m->count == 0)
4420 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = 0;
4421 1.1 skrll else
4422 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4423 1.1 skrll
4424 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4425 1.1 skrll && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4426 1.1 skrll {
4427 1.1 skrll /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
4428 1.1 skrll the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
4429 1.1 skrll objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
4430 1.1 skrll value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
4431 1.1 skrll may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
4432 1.1 skrll segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
4433 1.1 skrll on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
4434 1.1 skrll segment. */
4435 1.1 skrll if (m->p_align_valid)
4436 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = m->p_align;
4437 1.1 skrll
4438 1.1 skrll p->p_align = maxpagesize;
4439 1.1 skrll }
4440 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_align_valid)
4441 1.1 skrll p->p_align = m->p_align;
4442 1.1 skrll else if (m->count == 0)
4443 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
4444 1.1 skrll else
4445 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 0;
4446 1.1 skrll
4447 1.1 skrll no_contents = FALSE;
4448 1.1 skrll off_adjust = 0;
4449 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4450 1.1 skrll && m->count > 0)
4451 1.1 skrll {
4452 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type align;
4453 1.1 skrll unsigned int align_power = 0;
4454 1.1 skrll
4455 1.1 skrll if (m->p_align_valid)
4456 1.1 skrll align = p->p_align;
4457 1.1 skrll else
4458 1.1 skrll {
4459 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4460 1.1 skrll {
4461 1.1 skrll unsigned int secalign;
4462 1.1 skrll
4463 1.1 skrll secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
4464 1.1 skrll if (secalign > align_power)
4465 1.1 skrll align_power = secalign;
4466 1.1 skrll }
4467 1.1 skrll align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
4468 1.1 skrll if (align < maxpagesize)
4469 1.1 skrll align = maxpagesize;
4470 1.1 skrll }
4471 1.1 skrll
4472 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4473 1.1 skrll if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
4474 1.1 skrll /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
4475 1.1 skrll it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
4476 1.1 skrll set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
4477 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
4478 1.1 skrll
4479 1.1 skrll /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
4480 1.1 skrll sections. */
4481 1.1 skrll no_contents = TRUE;
4482 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4483 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
4484 1.1 skrll {
4485 1.1 skrll no_contents = FALSE;
4486 1.1 skrll break;
4487 1.3 christos }
4488 1.1 skrll
4489 1.1 skrll off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
4490 1.1 skrll off += off_adjust;
4491 1.1 skrll if (no_contents)
4492 1.1 skrll {
4493 1.1 skrll /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
4494 1.1 skrll the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
4495 1.1 skrll arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
4496 1.1 skrll checks it. So to comply with the alignment
4497 1.1 skrll requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
4498 1.1 skrll p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
4499 1.1 skrll subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
4500 1.1 skrll past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
4501 1.1 skrll }
4502 1.1 skrll else
4503 1.1 skrll off_adjust = 0;
4504 1.1 skrll }
4505 1.1 skrll /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
4506 1.1 skrll PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4507 1.1 skrll else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
4508 1.1 skrll && m->count > 1
4509 1.1 skrll && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
4510 1.1 skrll {
4511 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
4512 1.1 skrll (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
4513 1.1 skrll abfd);
4514 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4515 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4516 1.1 skrll }
4517 1.1 skrll /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
4518 1.1 skrll else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
4519 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4520 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
4521 1.1 skrll
4522 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = 0;
4523 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = 0;
4524 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = 0;
4525 1.1 skrll
4526 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
4527 1.1 skrll {
4528 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4529 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4530 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4531 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4532 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 0)
4533 1.1 skrll {
4534 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
4535 1.1 skrll
4536 1.1 skrll if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
4537 1.1 skrll {
4538 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
4539 1.1 skrll (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
4540 1.1 skrll abfd);
4541 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4542 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4543 1.1 skrll }
4544 1.1 skrll
4545 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr -= off;
4546 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4547 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr -= off;
4548 1.1 skrll }
4549 1.1 skrll }
4550 1.1 skrll
4551 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_phdrs)
4552 1.1 skrll {
4553 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4554 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4555 1.1 skrll
4556 1.1 skrll if (!m->includes_filehdr)
4557 1.1 skrll {
4558 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4559 1.1 skrll
4560 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 0)
4561 1.1 skrll {
4562 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
4563 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4564 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4565 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4566 1.1 skrll }
4567 1.1 skrll }
4568 1.1 skrll
4569 1.2 skrll p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4570 1.2 skrll p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4571 1.2 skrll if (m->count)
4572 1.2 skrll {
4573 1.2 skrll p->p_filesz += header_pad;
4574 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += header_pad;
4575 1.1 skrll }
4576 1.1 skrll }
4577 1.1 skrll
4578 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4579 1.1 skrll || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
4580 1.1 skrll {
4581 1.1 skrll if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
4582 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = off;
4583 1.1 skrll else
4584 1.1 skrll {
4585 1.1 skrll file_ptr adjust;
4586 1.1 skrll
4587 1.1 skrll adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
4588 1.1 skrll if (!no_contents)
4589 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += adjust;
4590 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += adjust;
4591 1.1 skrll }
4592 1.1 skrll }
4593 1.1 skrll
4594 1.1 skrll /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
4595 1.1 skrll maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
4596 1.1 skrll core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
4597 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
4598 1.1 skrll for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
4599 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4600 1.1 skrll {
4601 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
4602 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type align;
4603 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4604 1.1 skrll
4605 1.1 skrll sec = *secpp;
4606 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
4607 1.1 skrll align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
4608 1.1 skrll
4609 1.1 skrll if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4610 1.1 skrll || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4611 1.1 skrll && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
4612 1.1 skrll || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
4613 1.1 skrll && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
4614 1.3 christos || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
4615 1.3 christos {
4616 1.3 christos bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
4617 1.3 christos bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
4618 1.3 christos bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
4619 1.3 christos bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
4620 1.3 christos
4621 1.3 christos if (adjust != 0
4622 1.1 skrll && (s_start < p_end
4623 1.1 skrll || p_end < p_start))
4624 1.3 christos {
4625 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
4626 1.1 skrll (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
4627 1.3 christos (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
4628 1.1 skrll adjust = 0;
4629 1.1 skrll sec->lma = p_end;
4630 1.1 skrll }
4631 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += adjust;
4632 1.1 skrll
4633 1.3 christos if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4634 1.3 christos {
4635 1.3 christos if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
4636 1.3 christos {
4637 1.3 christos /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
4638 1.3 christos Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
4639 1.3 christos zero it. */
4640 1.3 christos adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
4641 1.3 christos if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
4642 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4643 1.1 skrll }
4644 1.1 skrll off += adjust;
4645 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += adjust;
4646 1.1 skrll }
4647 1.1 skrll }
4648 1.1 skrll
4649 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
4650 1.1 skrll {
4651 1.1 skrll /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
4652 1.1 skrll everything. */
4653 1.1 skrll if (i == 0)
4654 1.1 skrll {
4655 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4656 1.1 skrll off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4657 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
4658 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = 0;
4659 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1;
4660 1.1 skrll }
4661 1.1 skrll else
4662 1.1 skrll {
4663 1.1 skrll /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
4664 1.1 skrll sec->filepos = 0;
4665 1.1 skrll sec->size = 0;
4666 1.1 skrll sec->flags = 0;
4667 1.1 skrll continue;
4668 1.1 skrll }
4669 1.1 skrll }
4670 1.1 skrll else
4671 1.1 skrll {
4672 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
4673 1.1 skrll {
4674 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4675 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4676 1.3 christos off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4677 1.3 christos }
4678 1.3 christos else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4679 1.3 christos && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
4680 1.3 christos && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
4681 1.3 christos {
4682 1.3 christos /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
4683 1.3 christos (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
4684 1.3 christos final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
4685 1.3 christos would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
4686 1.3 christos p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
4687 1.3 christos also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
4688 1.3 christos p_offset value. */
4689 1.3 christos bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
4690 1.3 christos off, align);
4691 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
4692 1.1 skrll }
4693 1.1 skrll
4694 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4695 1.1 skrll {
4696 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4697 1.1 skrll /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
4698 1.1 skrll a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
4699 1.1 skrll file space but are not loaded into memory. */
4700 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4701 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4702 1.1 skrll }
4703 1.1 skrll else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4704 1.1 skrll {
4705 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4706 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4707 1.1 skrll
4708 1.1 skrll /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
4709 1.1 skrll normal segments. */
4710 1.1 skrll else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
4711 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4712 1.1 skrll }
4713 1.1 skrll
4714 1.1 skrll if (align > p->p_align
4715 1.1 skrll && !m->p_align_valid
4716 1.1 skrll && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4717 1.1 skrll || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
4718 1.1 skrll p->p_align = align;
4719 1.1 skrll }
4720 1.1 skrll
4721 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4722 1.1 skrll {
4723 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4724 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
4725 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_X;
4726 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
4727 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_W;
4728 1.1 skrll }
4729 1.1 skrll }
4730 1.1 skrll off -= off_adjust;
4731 1.1 skrll
4732 1.1 skrll /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
4733 1.3 christos Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
4734 1.3 christos if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
4735 1.1 skrll {
4736 1.3 christos bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
4737 1.3 christos
4738 1.3 christos for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
4739 1.3 christos if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
4740 1.3 christos && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
4741 1.3 christos ->this_hdr), p) != 0
4742 1.1 skrll && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
4743 1.3 christos ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
4744 1.3 christos {
4745 1.3 christos /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
4746 1.1 skrll check_vma = FALSE;
4747 1.3 christos break;
4748 1.3 christos }
4749 1.3 christos
4750 1.3 christos for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4751 1.3 christos {
4752 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4753 1.3 christos asection *sec;
4754 1.3 christos
4755 1.3 christos sec = m->sections[i];
4756 1.3 christos this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
4757 1.3 christos if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
4758 1.3 christos && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
4759 1.3 christos {
4760 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
4761 1.3 christos (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
4762 1.3 christos abfd, sec, j);
4763 1.3 christos print_segment_map (m);
4764 1.3 christos }
4765 1.1 skrll }
4766 1.1 skrll }
4767 1.1 skrll }
4768 1.1 skrll
4769 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
4770 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4771 1.1 skrll }
4772 1.1 skrll
4773 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
4774 1.1 skrll
4775 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4776 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4777 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4778 1.1 skrll {
4779 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4780 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
4781 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
4782 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4783 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4784 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4785 1.1 skrll bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
4786 1.1 skrll bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
4787 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
4788 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_sec;
4789 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4790 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
4791 1.1 skrll
4792 1.1 skrll i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4793 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
4794 1.1 skrll off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
4795 1.1 skrll for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
4796 1.1 skrll {
4797 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
4798 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4799 1.1 skrll
4800 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
4801 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4802 1.1 skrll && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
4803 1.1 skrll || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4804 1.1 skrll && hdr->contents == NULL)))
4805 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
4806 1.3 christos else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4807 1.3 christos {
4808 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
4809 1.3 christos (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
4810 1.3 christos abfd,
4811 1.3 christos (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
4812 1.1 skrll ? "*unknown*"
4813 1.1 skrll : hdr->bfd_section->name));
4814 1.1 skrll /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
4815 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
4816 1.1 skrll off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4817 1.1 skrll bed->maxpagesize);
4818 1.1 skrll else
4819 1.1 skrll off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4820 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_addralign);
4821 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
4822 1.1 skrll FALSE);
4823 1.1 skrll }
4824 1.1 skrll else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
4825 1.1 skrll && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
4826 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_section]
4827 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_shndx_section]
4828 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->strtab_section])
4829 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_offset = -1;
4830 1.1 skrll else
4831 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4832 1.1 skrll }
4833 1.1 skrll
4834 1.1 skrll /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
4835 1.1 skrll the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
4836 1.1 skrll count = 0;
4837 1.1 skrll filehdr_vaddr = 0;
4838 1.1 skrll filehdr_paddr = 0;
4839 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4840 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr = 0;
4841 1.1 skrll phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4842 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
4843 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
4844 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++)
4845 1.1 skrll {
4846 1.1 skrll ++count;
4847 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
4848 1.1 skrll continue;
4849 1.1 skrll
4850 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
4851 1.1 skrll {
4852 1.1 skrll filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4853 1.1 skrll filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4854 1.1 skrll }
4855 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_phdrs)
4856 1.1 skrll {
4857 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4858 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4859 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
4860 1.1 skrll {
4861 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4862 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4863 1.1 skrll }
4864 1.1 skrll }
4865 1.1 skrll }
4866 1.1 skrll
4867 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
4868 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
4869 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++)
4870 1.1 skrll {
4871 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
4872 1.1 skrll {
4873 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
4874 1.1 skrll
4875 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
4876 1.1 skrll
4877 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
4878 1.1 skrll {
4879 1.1 skrll /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
4880 1.1 skrll in link_info. */
4881 1.1 skrll for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
4882 1.1 skrll {
4883 1.1 skrll if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
4884 1.1 skrll && lp->p_vaddr >= link_info->relro_start
4885 1.1 skrll && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
4886 1.1 skrll && lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz >= link_info->relro_end)
4887 1.1 skrll break;
4888 1.1 skrll }
4889 1.1 skrll }
4890 1.1 skrll else
4891 1.1 skrll {
4892 1.1 skrll /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
4893 1.1 skrll library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
4894 1.1 skrll for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
4895 1.1 skrll {
4896 1.1 skrll if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
4897 1.1 skrll && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
4898 1.1 skrll break;
4899 1.1 skrll }
4900 1.1 skrll }
4901 1.1 skrll
4902 1.1 skrll if (lp < phdrs + count)
4903 1.1 skrll {
4904 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
4905 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
4906 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
4907 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
4908 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
4909 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_size_valid)
4910 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
4911 1.1 skrll else
4912 1.1 skrll abort ();
4913 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
4914 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1;
4915 1.3 christos p->p_flags = (lp->p_flags & ~PF_W);
4916 1.1 skrll }
4917 1.1 skrll else
4918 1.1 skrll {
4919 1.1 skrll memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
4920 1.1 skrll p->p_type = PT_NULL;
4921 1.1 skrll }
4922 1.1 skrll }
4923 1.1 skrll else if (m->count != 0)
4924 1.1 skrll {
4925 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4926 1.1 skrll && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
4927 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
4928 1.1 skrll {
4929 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
4930 1.1 skrll
4931 1.3 christos p->p_filesz = 0;
4932 1.3 christos p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
4933 1.3 christos for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
4934 1.3 christos {
4935 1.3 christos asection *sect = m->sections[i];
4936 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
4937 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4938 1.3 christos {
4939 1.3 christos p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
4940 1.3 christos + hdr->sh_size);
4941 1.3 christos break;
4942 1.1 skrll }
4943 1.1 skrll }
4944 1.1 skrll }
4945 1.1 skrll }
4946 1.1 skrll else if (m->includes_filehdr)
4947 1.1 skrll {
4948 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
4949 1.1 skrll if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
4950 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
4951 1.1 skrll }
4952 1.1 skrll else if (m->includes_phdrs)
4953 1.1 skrll {
4954 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
4955 1.1 skrll if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
4956 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
4957 1.1 skrll }
4958 1.1 skrll }
4959 1.1 skrll
4960 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
4961 1.1 skrll
4962 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4963 1.1 skrll }
4964 1.1 skrll
4965 1.1 skrll /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
4966 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
4967 1.1 skrll VMAs must be known before this is called.
4968 1.1 skrll
4969 1.1 skrll Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
4970 1.1 skrll "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
4971 1.1 skrll those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
4972 1.1 skrll stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
4973 1.1 skrll consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
4974 1.1 skrll image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
4975 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
4976 1.1 skrll
4977 1.1 skrll We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
4978 1.1 skrll
4979 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4980 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
4981 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4982 1.1 skrll {
4983 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
4984 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
4985 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
4986 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4987 1.1 skrll
4988 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
4989 1.1 skrll && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
4990 1.1 skrll {
4991 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4992 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
4993 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
4994 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4995 1.1 skrll
4996 1.1 skrll /* Start after the ELF header. */
4997 1.1 skrll off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
4998 1.1 skrll
4999 1.1 skrll /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
5000 1.1 skrll not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
5001 1.1 skrll the sections in the file is unimportant. */
5002 1.1 skrll for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
5003 1.1 skrll {
5004 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5005 1.1 skrll
5006 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
5007 1.1 skrll if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5008 1.1 skrll && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5009 1.1 skrll || i == tdata->symtab_section
5010 1.1 skrll || i == tdata->symtab_shndx_section
5011 1.1 skrll || i == tdata->strtab_section)
5012 1.1 skrll {
5013 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5014 1.1 skrll }
5015 1.1 skrll else
5016 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5017 1.1 skrll }
5018 1.1 skrll }
5019 1.1 skrll else
5020 1.1 skrll {
5021 1.1 skrll unsigned int alloc;
5022 1.1 skrll
5023 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
5024 1.1 skrll assignment of sections to segments. */
5025 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5026 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5027 1.1 skrll
5028 1.1 skrll /* And for non-load sections. */
5029 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5030 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5031 1.1 skrll
5032 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
5033 1.1 skrll {
5034 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
5035 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5036 1.1 skrll }
5037 1.1 skrll
5038 1.1 skrll /* Write out the program headers. */
5039 1.1 skrll alloc = tdata->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5040 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
5041 1.1 skrll || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
5042 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5043 1.1 skrll
5044 1.1 skrll off = tdata->next_file_pos;
5045 1.1 skrll }
5046 1.1 skrll
5047 1.1 skrll /* Place the section headers. */
5048 1.1 skrll off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
5049 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
5050 1.1 skrll off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
5051 1.1 skrll
5052 1.1 skrll tdata->next_file_pos = off;
5053 1.1 skrll
5054 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5055 1.1 skrll }
5056 1.1 skrll
5057 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5058 1.3 christos prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
5059 1.1 skrll {
5060 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
5061 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
5062 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5063 1.1 skrll
5064 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5065 1.1 skrll
5066 1.1 skrll shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
5067 1.1 skrll if (shstrtab == NULL)
5068 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5069 1.1 skrll
5070 1.1 skrll elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
5071 1.1 skrll
5072 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
5073 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
5074 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
5075 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
5076 1.1 skrll
5077 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
5078 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
5079 1.1 skrll bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
5080 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
5081 1.1 skrll
5082 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5083 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
5084 1.1 skrll else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
5085 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5086 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5087 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
5088 1.1 skrll else
5089 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
5090 1.1 skrll
5091 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
5092 1.1 skrll {
5093 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_unknown:
5094 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
5095 1.1 skrll break;
5096 1.1 skrll
5097 1.1 skrll /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
5098 1.1 skrll e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
5099 1.1 skrll in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
5100 1.1 skrll the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
5101 1.1 skrll can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
5102 1.1 skrll unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
5103 1.1 skrll Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
5104 1.1 skrll e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
5105 1.1 skrll default:
5106 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
5107 1.1 skrll }
5108 1.1 skrll
5109 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
5110 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5111 1.1 skrll
5112 1.1 skrll /* No program header, for now. */
5113 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5114 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5115 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
5116 1.1 skrll
5117 1.1 skrll /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
5118 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
5119 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
5120 1.1 skrll
5121 1.1 skrll /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
5122 1.1 skrll if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
5123 1.1 skrll /* It all happens later. */
5124 1.1 skrll ;
5125 1.1 skrll else
5126 1.1 skrll {
5127 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5128 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5129 1.1 skrll }
5130 1.1 skrll
5131 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
5132 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
5133 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
5134 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
5135 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
5136 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
5137 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5138 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5139 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
5140 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5141 1.1 skrll
5142 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5143 1.1 skrll }
5144 1.1 skrll
5145 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
5146 1.1 skrll of the loadable file image. */
5147 1.1 skrll
5148 1.1 skrll void
5149 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (bfd *abfd)
5150 1.1 skrll {
5151 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
5152 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
5153 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp;
5154 1.1 skrll
5155 1.1 skrll off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
5156 1.1 skrll
5157 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5158 1.1 skrll for (i = 1, shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1; i < num_sec; i++, shdrpp++)
5159 1.1 skrll {
5160 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
5161 1.1 skrll
5162 1.1 skrll shdrp = *shdrpp;
5163 1.1 skrll if ((shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5164 1.1 skrll && shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
5165 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
5166 1.1 skrll }
5167 1.1 skrll
5168 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
5169 1.1 skrll }
5170 1.1 skrll
5171 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
5172 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
5173 1.1 skrll {
5174 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5175 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
5176 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean failed;
5177 1.1 skrll unsigned int count, num_sec;
5178 1.1 skrll
5179 1.1 skrll if (! abfd->output_has_begun
5180 1.1 skrll && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
5181 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5182 1.1 skrll
5183 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5184 1.1 skrll
5185 1.1 skrll failed = FALSE;
5186 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
5187 1.1 skrll if (failed)
5188 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5189 1.1 skrll
5190 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (abfd);
5191 1.1 skrll
5192 1.1 skrll /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
5193 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5194 1.1 skrll for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
5195 1.1 skrll {
5196 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
5197 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
5198 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
5199 1.1 skrll {
5200 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
5201 1.1 skrll
5202 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5203 1.1 skrll || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
5204 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5205 1.1 skrll }
5206 1.1 skrll }
5207 1.1 skrll
5208 1.1 skrll /* Write out the section header names. */
5209 1.1 skrll if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
5210 1.1 skrll && (bfd_seek (abfd, elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5211 1.1 skrll || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
5212 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5213 1.1 skrll
5214 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
5215 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd,
5216 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->linker);
5217 1.1 skrll
5218 1.1 skrll if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
5219 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5220 1.1 skrll
5221 1.1 skrll /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
5222 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->after_write_object_contents)
5223 1.1 skrll return (*elf_tdata (abfd)->after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
5224 1.1 skrll
5225 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5226 1.1 skrll }
5227 1.1 skrll
5228 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
5229 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
5230 1.1 skrll {
5231 1.1 skrll /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
5232 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
5233 1.1 skrll }
5234 1.1 skrll
5235 1.1 skrll /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
5236 1.1 skrll
5237 1.1 skrll unsigned int
5238 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
5239 1.3 christos {
5240 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5241 1.1 skrll unsigned int sec_index;
5242 1.1 skrll
5243 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
5244 1.1 skrll && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
5245 1.1 skrll return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
5246 1.3 christos
5247 1.1 skrll if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
5248 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_ABS;
5249 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
5250 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
5251 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
5252 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
5253 1.1 skrll else
5254 1.1 skrll sec_index = SHN_BAD;
5255 1.1 skrll
5256 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5257 1.3 christos if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
5258 1.1 skrll {
5259 1.1 skrll int retval = sec_index;
5260 1.1 skrll
5261 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
5262 1.1 skrll return retval;
5263 1.3 christos }
5264 1.1 skrll
5265 1.1 skrll if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
5266 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
5267 1.1 skrll
5268 1.1 skrll return sec_index;
5269 1.1 skrll }
5270 1.1 skrll
5271 1.1 skrll /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
5272 1.1 skrll on error. */
5273 1.1 skrll
5274 1.1 skrll int
5275 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
5276 1.1 skrll {
5277 1.1 skrll asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
5278 1.1 skrll int idx;
5279 1.1 skrll flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
5280 1.1 skrll
5281 1.1 skrll /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
5282 1.1 skrll own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
5283 1.1 skrll symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
5284 1.1 skrll relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
5285 1.1 skrll input sections rather than the output section. */
5286 1.1 skrll if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
5287 1.1 skrll && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
5288 1.1 skrll && asym_ptr->section)
5289 1.1 skrll {
5290 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
5291 1.1 skrll int indx;
5292 1.1 skrll
5293 1.1 skrll sec = asym_ptr->section;
5294 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
5295 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
5296 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner == abfd
5297 1.1 skrll && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
5298 1.1 skrll && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
5299 1.1 skrll asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
5300 1.1 skrll }
5301 1.1 skrll
5302 1.1 skrll idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
5303 1.1 skrll
5304 1.1 skrll if (idx == 0)
5305 1.1 skrll {
5306 1.1 skrll /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
5307 1.1 skrll which is used in a relocation entry. */
5308 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
5309 1.1 skrll (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
5310 1.1 skrll abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
5311 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
5312 1.1 skrll return -1;
5313 1.1 skrll }
5314 1.1 skrll
5315 1.1 skrll #if DEBUG & 4
5316 1.3 christos {
5317 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr,
5318 1.1 skrll "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
5319 1.1 skrll (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
5320 1.1 skrll fflush (stderr);
5321 1.1 skrll }
5322 1.1 skrll #endif
5323 1.1 skrll
5324 1.1 skrll return idx;
5325 1.1 skrll }
5326 1.1 skrll
5327 1.1 skrll /* Rewrite program header information. */
5328 1.1 skrll
5329 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5330 1.1 skrll rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5331 1.1 skrll {
5332 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5333 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map;
5334 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5335 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5336 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5337 1.1 skrll asection *section;
5338 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
5339 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_segments;
5340 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
5341 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
5342 1.1 skrll bfd_vma maxpagesize;
5343 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
5344 1.1 skrll unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
5345 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5346 1.1 skrll
5347 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
5348 1.1 skrll iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
5349 1.1 skrll
5350 1.1 skrll map_first = NULL;
5351 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map_first;
5352 1.1 skrll
5353 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5354 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
5355 1.1 skrll
5356 1.1 skrll /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
5357 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
5358 1.1 skrll (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
5359 1.1 skrll ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
5360 1.1 skrll
5361 1.1 skrll #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
5362 1.1 skrll (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5363 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
5364 1.1 skrll ? section->size : 0)
5365 1.1 skrll
5366 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5367 1.1 skrll the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
5368 1.1 skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
5369 1.1 skrll (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
5370 1.1 skrll && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5371 1.1 skrll <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
5372 1.1 skrll
5373 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5374 1.1 skrll the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
5375 1.1 skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
5376 1.1 skrll (section->lma >= base \
5377 1.1 skrll && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5378 1.1 skrll <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
5379 1.1 skrll
5380 1.1 skrll /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
5381 1.1 skrll #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
5382 1.1 skrll (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
5383 1.1 skrll && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
5384 1.1 skrll && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5385 1.1 skrll && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5386 1.1 skrll <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5387 1.1 skrll
5388 1.1 skrll /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
5389 1.1 skrll etc. */
5390 1.1 skrll #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
5391 1.1 skrll (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
5392 1.1 skrll && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
5393 1.1 skrll && s->vma == 0 \
5394 1.1 skrll && s->lma == 0)
5395 1.1 skrll
5396 1.1 skrll /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
5397 1.1 skrll linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
5398 1.1 skrll p_memsz set to 0. */
5399 1.1 skrll #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
5400 1.1 skrll (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
5401 1.1 skrll && p->p_paddr == 0 \
5402 1.1 skrll && p->p_memsz == 0 \
5403 1.1 skrll && p->p_filesz > 0 \
5404 1.1 skrll && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
5405 1.1 skrll && s->size > 0 \
5406 1.1 skrll && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5407 1.1 skrll && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5408 1.1 skrll <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5409 1.1 skrll
5410 1.1 skrll /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
5411 1.1 skrll A section will be included if:
5412 1.1 skrll 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
5413 1.1 skrll if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
5414 1.1 skrll 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
5415 1.1 skrll segment.
5416 1.1 skrll 3. There is an output section associated with it,
5417 1.1 skrll 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
5418 1.1 skrll 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
5419 1.1 skrll 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
5420 1.1 skrll 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
5421 1.1 skrll 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
5422 1.1 skrll (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
5423 1.1 skrll #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
5424 1.1 skrll ((((segment->p_paddr \
5425 1.1 skrll ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
5426 1.1 skrll : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
5427 1.1 skrll && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
5428 1.1 skrll || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
5429 1.1 skrll && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
5430 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
5431 1.1 skrll || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5432 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
5433 1.1 skrll || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
5434 1.1 skrll || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
5435 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
5436 1.1 skrll || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
5437 1.1 skrll || (segment->p_paddr \
5438 1.1 skrll ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
5439 1.1 skrll : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
5440 1.1 skrll || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
5441 1.1 skrll == 0)) \
5442 1.1 skrll && !section->segment_mark)
5443 1.1 skrll
5444 1.1 skrll /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
5445 1.1 skrll it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
5446 1.1 skrll #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
5447 1.1 skrll (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
5448 1.1 skrll && section->output_section != NULL)
5449 1.1 skrll
5450 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
5451 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
5452 1.1 skrll (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
5453 1.1 skrll
5454 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
5455 1.1 skrll their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
5456 1.1 skrll It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
5457 1.1 skrll ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
5458 1.1 skrll to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
5459 1.1 skrll LMA. */
5460 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
5461 1.1 skrll ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
5462 1.1 skrll || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
5463 1.1 skrll && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
5464 1.1 skrll || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
5465 1.1 skrll
5466 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
5467 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5468 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
5469 1.1 skrll
5470 1.1 skrll /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
5471 1.1 skrll p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
5472 1.1 skrll file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
5473 1.1 skrll don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
5474 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
5475 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5476 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
5477 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
5478 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
5479 1.1 skrll {
5480 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
5481 1.1 skrll break;
5482 1.1 skrll }
5483 1.1 skrll
5484 1.1 skrll /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
5485 1.1 skrll of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
5486 1.1 skrll in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
5487 1.1 skrll parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
5488 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5489 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
5490 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
5491 1.1 skrll {
5492 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
5493 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
5494 1.1 skrll
5495 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
5496 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
5497 1.1 skrll if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
5498 1.1 skrll {
5499 1.1 skrll /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
5500 1.1 skrll assignment code will work. */
5501 1.1 skrll segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
5502 1.1 skrll break;
5503 1.1 skrll }
5504 1.1 skrll
5505 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5506 1.1 skrll {
5507 1.1 skrll /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
5508 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5509 1.1 skrll segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5510 1.1 skrll continue;
5511 1.1 skrll }
5512 1.1 skrll
5513 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
5514 1.1 skrll for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
5515 1.1 skrll {
5516 1.1 skrll bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
5517 1.1 skrll
5518 1.1 skrll if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
5519 1.1 skrll || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
5520 1.1 skrll continue;
5521 1.1 skrll
5522 1.1 skrll /* Merge the two segments together. */
5523 1.1 skrll if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
5524 1.1 skrll {
5525 1.1 skrll /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
5526 1.1 skrll SEGMENT. */
5527 1.1 skrll extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
5528 1.1 skrll - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
5529 1.1 skrll
5530 1.1 skrll if (extra_length > 0)
5531 1.1 skrll {
5532 1.1 skrll segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
5533 1.1 skrll segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
5534 1.1 skrll }
5535 1.1 skrll
5536 1.1 skrll segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5537 1.1 skrll
5538 1.1 skrll /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
5539 1.1 skrll i = 0;
5540 1.1 skrll segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5541 1.1 skrll break;
5542 1.1 skrll }
5543 1.1 skrll else
5544 1.1 skrll {
5545 1.1 skrll /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
5546 1.1 skrll SEGMENT2. */
5547 1.1 skrll extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
5548 1.1 skrll - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
5549 1.1 skrll
5550 1.1 skrll if (extra_length > 0)
5551 1.1 skrll {
5552 1.1 skrll segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
5553 1.1 skrll segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
5554 1.1 skrll }
5555 1.1 skrll
5556 1.1 skrll segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
5557 1.1 skrll }
5558 1.1 skrll }
5559 1.1 skrll }
5560 1.1 skrll
5561 1.1 skrll /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
5562 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5563 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
5564 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
5565 1.1 skrll {
5566 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_count;
5567 1.1 skrll asection **sections;
5568 1.1 skrll asection *output_section;
5569 1.1 skrll unsigned int isec;
5570 1.1 skrll bfd_vma matching_lma;
5571 1.1 skrll bfd_vma suggested_lma;
5572 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
5573 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
5574 1.1 skrll asection *first_section;
5575 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
5576 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
5577 1.1 skrll
5578 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
5579 1.1 skrll continue;
5580 1.1 skrll
5581 1.1 skrll first_section = NULL;
5582 1.1 skrll /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
5583 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
5584 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
5585 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
5586 1.1 skrll {
5587 1.1 skrll /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
5588 1.1 skrll removed from the corresponding output segment. */
5589 1.1 skrll if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5590 1.1 skrll {
5591 1.1 skrll if (first_section == NULL)
5592 1.1 skrll first_section = section;
5593 1.1 skrll if (section->output_section != NULL)
5594 1.1 skrll ++section_count;
5595 1.1 skrll }
5596 1.1 skrll }
5597 1.1 skrll
5598 1.1 skrll /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
5599 1.1 skrll all of the sections we have selected. */
5600 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5601 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5602 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
5603 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
5604 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5605 1.1 skrll
5606 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
5607 1.1 skrll using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
5608 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
5609 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5610 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5611 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5612 1.1 skrll
5613 1.1 skrll /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
5614 1.1 skrll no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
5615 1.1 skrll output segment. */
5616 1.1 skrll if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
5617 1.1 skrll {
5618 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
5619 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
5620 1.1 skrll }
5621 1.1 skrll
5622 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
5623 1.1 skrll and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
5624 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
5625 1.1 skrll && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
5626 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5627 1.1 skrll
5628 1.1 skrll if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5629 1.1 skrll {
5630 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs =
5631 1.1 skrll (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5632 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
5633 1.1 skrll >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5634 1.1 skrll + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
5635 1.1 skrll
5636 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
5637 1.1 skrll phdr_included = TRUE;
5638 1.1 skrll }
5639 1.1 skrll
5640 1.1 skrll if (section_count == 0)
5641 1.1 skrll {
5642 1.1 skrll /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
5643 1.1 skrll no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
5644 1.1 skrll something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
5645 1.1 skrll a warning is produced. */
5646 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5647 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment"
5648 1.1 skrll " detected, is this intentional ?\n"),
5649 1.1 skrll ibfd);
5650 1.1 skrll
5651 1.1 skrll map->count = 0;
5652 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
5653 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5654 1.1 skrll
5655 1.1 skrll continue;
5656 1.1 skrll }
5657 1.1 skrll
5658 1.1 skrll /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
5659 1.1 skrll to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
5660 1.1 skrll The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
5661 1.1 skrll been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
5662 1.1 skrll
5663 1.1 skrll 1. None of the sections have been moved.
5664 1.1 skrll In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
5665 1.1 skrll input BFD.
5666 1.1 skrll
5667 1.1 skrll 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
5668 1.1 skrll In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5669 1.1 skrll of the first section.
5670 1.1 skrll
5671 1.1 skrll 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
5672 1.1 skrll In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
5673 1.1 skrll placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
5674 1.1 skrll and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
5675 1.1 skrll have to be created to contain the other sections.
5676 1.1 skrll
5677 1.1 skrll 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
5678 1.1 skrll In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5679 1.1 skrll of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
5680 1.1 skrll or segments to contain the other sections.
5681 1.1 skrll
5682 1.1 skrll In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
5683 1.1 skrll pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
5684 1.3 christos to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
5685 1.1 skrll
5686 1.1 skrll sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
5687 1.1 skrll if (sections == NULL)
5688 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5689 1.1 skrll
5690 1.1 skrll /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
5691 1.1 skrll Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
5692 1.1 skrll Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
5693 1.1 skrll case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
5694 1.1 skrll we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
5695 1.1 skrll more to do. */
5696 1.1 skrll isec = 0;
5697 1.1 skrll matching_lma = 0;
5698 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = 0;
5699 1.1 skrll first_matching_lma = TRUE;
5700 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
5701 1.1 skrll
5702 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections;
5703 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
5704 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
5705 1.1 skrll if (section == first_section)
5706 1.1 skrll break;
5707 1.1 skrll
5708 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5709 1.1 skrll {
5710 1.1 skrll if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5711 1.1 skrll {
5712 1.1 skrll output_section = section->output_section;
5713 1.1 skrll
5714 1.1 skrll sections[j++] = section;
5715 1.1 skrll
5716 1.1 skrll /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
5717 1.1 skrll We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
5718 1.1 skrll correct value. Note - some backends require that
5719 1.1 skrll p_paddr be left as zero. */
5720 1.1 skrll if (!p_paddr_valid
5721 1.1 skrll && segment->p_vaddr != 0
5722 1.1 skrll && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5723 1.1 skrll && isec == 0
5724 1.1 skrll && output_section->lma != 0
5725 1.1 skrll && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
5726 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_filehdr
5727 1.1 skrll ? iehdr->e_ehsize
5728 1.1 skrll : 0)
5729 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_phdrs
5730 1.1 skrll ? (iehdr->e_phnum
5731 1.1 skrll * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5732 1.1 skrll : 0)))
5733 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5734 1.1 skrll
5735 1.1 skrll /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
5736 1.1 skrll LMA address of the output section. */
5737 1.1 skrll if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5738 1.1 skrll || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
5739 1.1 skrll || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5740 1.1 skrll && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
5741 1.1 skrll {
5742 1.1 skrll if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
5743 1.1 skrll {
5744 1.1 skrll matching_lma = output_section->lma;
5745 1.1 skrll first_matching_lma = FALSE;
5746 1.1 skrll }
5747 1.1 skrll
5748 1.1 skrll /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
5749 1.1 skrll then it does not overlap any other section within that
5750 1.1 skrll segment. */
5751 1.1 skrll map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
5752 1.1 skrll }
5753 1.1 skrll else if (first_suggested_lma)
5754 1.1 skrll {
5755 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5756 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5757 1.1 skrll }
5758 1.1 skrll
5759 1.1 skrll if (j == section_count)
5760 1.1 skrll break;
5761 1.1 skrll }
5762 1.1 skrll }
5763 1.1 skrll
5764 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
5765 1.1 skrll
5766 1.1 skrll /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
5767 1.1 skrll if necessary. */
5768 1.1 skrll if (isec == section_count)
5769 1.1 skrll {
5770 1.1 skrll /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
5771 1.1 skrll specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
5772 1.1 skrll the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
5773 1.1 skrll program header in the input BFD. */
5774 1.1 skrll map->count = section_count;
5775 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
5776 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5777 1.1 skrll
5778 1.1 skrll if (p_paddr_valid
5779 1.1 skrll && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5780 1.1 skrll && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
5781 1.1 skrll && !map->includes_filehdr
5782 1.1 skrll && !map->includes_phdrs)
5783 1.1 skrll /* There is some padding before the first section in the
5784 1.1 skrll segment. So, we must account for that in the output
5785 1.1 skrll segment's vma. */
5786 1.1 skrll map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
5787 1.1 skrll
5788 1.1 skrll free (sections);
5789 1.1 skrll continue;
5790 1.1 skrll }
5791 1.1 skrll else
5792 1.1 skrll {
5793 1.1 skrll if (!first_matching_lma)
5794 1.1 skrll {
5795 1.1 skrll /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
5796 1.1 skrll Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
5797 1.1 skrll LMA of the first section that fitted. */
5798 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
5799 1.1 skrll }
5800 1.1 skrll else
5801 1.1 skrll {
5802 1.1 skrll /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
5803 1.1 skrll Change the current segment's physical address to match
5804 1.1 skrll the LMA of the first section. */
5805 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5806 1.1 skrll }
5807 1.1 skrll
5808 1.1 skrll /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
5809 1.1 skrll to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
5810 1.1 skrll if (map->includes_filehdr)
5811 1.1 skrll {
5812 1.1 skrll if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
5813 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
5814 1.1 skrll else
5815 1.1 skrll {
5816 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
5817 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
5818 1.1 skrll }
5819 1.1 skrll }
5820 1.1 skrll
5821 1.1 skrll if (map->includes_phdrs)
5822 1.1 skrll {
5823 1.1 skrll if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5824 1.1 skrll {
5825 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5826 1.1 skrll
5827 1.1 skrll /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
5828 1.1 skrll of program headers that we will need. Make a note
5829 1.1 skrll here of the number we used and the segment we chose
5830 1.1 skrll to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
5831 1.1 skrll offset when we know the correct value. */
5832 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
5833 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_seg = map;
5834 1.1 skrll }
5835 1.1 skrll else
5836 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
5837 1.1 skrll }
5838 1.1 skrll }
5839 1.1 skrll
5840 1.1 skrll /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
5841 1.1 skrll those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
5842 1.1 skrll sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
5843 1.1 skrll possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
5844 1.1 skrll added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
5845 1.1 skrll to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
5846 1.1 skrll the loop. */
5847 1.1 skrll isec = 0;
5848 1.1 skrll do
5849 1.1 skrll {
5850 1.1 skrll map->count = 0;
5851 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = 0;
5852 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
5853 1.1 skrll
5854 1.1 skrll /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
5855 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
5856 1.1 skrll {
5857 1.1 skrll section = sections[j];
5858 1.1 skrll
5859 1.1 skrll if (section == NULL)
5860 1.1 skrll continue;
5861 1.1 skrll
5862 1.1 skrll output_section = section->output_section;
5863 1.1 skrll
5864 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
5865 1.1 skrll
5866 1.1 skrll if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5867 1.1 skrll || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
5868 1.1 skrll {
5869 1.1 skrll if (map->count == 0)
5870 1.1 skrll {
5871 1.1 skrll /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
5872 1.1 skrll the beginning of the segment, then something is
5873 1.1 skrll wrong. */
5874 1.1 skrll if (output_section->lma
5875 1.1 skrll != (map->p_paddr
5876 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
5877 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_phdrs
5878 1.1 skrll ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
5879 1.1 skrll : 0)))
5880 1.1 skrll abort ();
5881 1.1 skrll }
5882 1.1 skrll else
5883 1.1 skrll {
5884 1.1 skrll asection *prev_sec;
5885 1.1 skrll
5886 1.1 skrll prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
5887 1.1 skrll
5888 1.1 skrll /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
5889 1.1 skrll and the start of this section is more than
5890 1.1 skrll maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
5891 1.1 skrll if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
5892 1.1 skrll maxpagesize)
5893 1.1 skrll < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
5894 1.1 skrll || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
5895 1.1 skrll > output_section->lma))
5896 1.1 skrll {
5897 1.1 skrll if (first_suggested_lma)
5898 1.1 skrll {
5899 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5900 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5901 1.1 skrll }
5902 1.1 skrll
5903 1.1 skrll continue;
5904 1.1 skrll }
5905 1.1 skrll }
5906 1.1 skrll
5907 1.1 skrll map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
5908 1.1 skrll ++isec;
5909 1.1 skrll sections[j] = NULL;
5910 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = TRUE;
5911 1.1 skrll }
5912 1.1 skrll else if (first_suggested_lma)
5913 1.1 skrll {
5914 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5915 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5916 1.1 skrll }
5917 1.1 skrll }
5918 1.1 skrll
5919 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
5920 1.1 skrll
5921 1.1 skrll /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
5922 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
5923 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5924 1.1 skrll
5925 1.1 skrll if (isec < section_count)
5926 1.1 skrll {
5927 1.1 skrll /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
5928 1.1 skrll segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
5929 1.1 skrll and carry on looping. */
5930 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5931 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5932 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_alloc (obfd, amt);
5933 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
5934 1.1 skrll {
5935 1.1 skrll free (sections);
5936 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5937 1.1 skrll }
5938 1.1 skrll
5939 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
5940 1.1 skrll physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
5941 1.1 skrll not yet been assigned. */
5942 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
5943 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5944 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5945 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5946 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5947 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
5948 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = 0;
5949 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5950 1.1 skrll }
5951 1.1 skrll }
5952 1.1 skrll while (isec < section_count);
5953 1.1 skrll
5954 1.1 skrll free (sections);
5955 1.1 skrll }
5956 1.1 skrll
5957 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
5958 1.1 skrll
5959 1.1 skrll /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
5960 1.1 skrll going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
5961 1.1 skrll the offset if necessary. */
5962 1.1 skrll if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
5963 1.1 skrll {
5964 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
5965 1.1 skrll
5966 1.1 skrll for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
5967 1.1 skrll count++;
5968 1.1 skrll
5969 1.1 skrll if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
5970 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
5971 1.1 skrll -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5972 1.1 skrll }
5973 1.1 skrll
5974 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_END
5975 1.1 skrll #undef SECTION_SIZE
5976 1.1 skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
5977 1.1 skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
5978 1.1 skrll #undef IS_NOTE
5979 1.1 skrll #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
5980 1.1 skrll #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
5981 1.1 skrll #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
5982 1.1 skrll #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
5983 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
5984 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
5985 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5986 1.1 skrll }
5987 1.1 skrll
5988 1.1 skrll /* Copy ELF program header information. */
5989 1.1 skrll
5990 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5991 1.1 skrll copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5992 1.1 skrll {
5993 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5994 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map;
5995 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5996 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5997 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5998 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
5999 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_segments;
6000 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6001 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6002 1.1 skrll
6003 1.1 skrll iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6004 1.1 skrll
6005 1.1 skrll map_first = NULL;
6006 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6007 1.1 skrll
6008 1.1 skrll /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
6009 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid. */
6010 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6011 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6012 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6013 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6014 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6015 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6016 1.1 skrll {
6017 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6018 1.1 skrll break;
6019 1.1 skrll }
6020 1.1 skrll
6021 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6022 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6023 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6024 1.1 skrll {
6025 1.1 skrll asection *section;
6026 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_count;
6027 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
6028 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6029 1.1 skrll asection *first_section = NULL;
6030 1.1 skrll asection *lowest_section;
6031 1.1 skrll
6032 1.1 skrll /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
6033 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6034 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6035 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6036 1.3 christos {
6037 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6038 1.3 christos if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6039 1.3 christos {
6040 1.1 skrll if (first_section == NULL)
6041 1.1 skrll first_section = section;
6042 1.1 skrll section_count++;
6043 1.1 skrll }
6044 1.1 skrll }
6045 1.1 skrll
6046 1.1 skrll /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6047 1.1 skrll all of the sections we have selected. */
6048 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6049 1.3 christos if (section_count != 0)
6050 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6051 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6052 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
6053 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6054 1.1 skrll
6055 1.1 skrll /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
6056 1.1 skrll input segment. */
6057 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
6058 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6059 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6060 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6061 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6062 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6063 1.1 skrll map->p_align = segment->p_align;
6064 1.1 skrll map->p_align_valid = 1;
6065 1.3 christos map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
6066 1.1 skrll
6067 1.1 skrll if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6068 1.1 skrll {
6069 1.1 skrll /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
6070 1.1 skrll bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
6071 1.3 christos section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
6072 1.1 skrll change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6073 1.1 skrll map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
6074 1.1 skrll map->p_size_valid = 1;
6075 1.1 skrll }
6076 1.1 skrll
6077 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6078 1.1 skrll and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6079 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6080 1.1 skrll && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6081 1.1 skrll
6082 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6083 1.1 skrll if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6084 1.1 skrll {
6085 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs =
6086 1.1 skrll (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6087 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6088 1.1 skrll >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6089 1.1 skrll + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6090 1.1 skrll
6091 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6092 1.1 skrll phdr_included = TRUE;
6093 1.3 christos }
6094 1.1 skrll
6095 1.1 skrll lowest_section = first_section;
6096 1.1 skrll if (section_count != 0)
6097 1.1 skrll {
6098 1.1 skrll unsigned int isec = 0;
6099 1.1 skrll
6100 1.1 skrll for (section = first_section;
6101 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6102 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6103 1.3 christos {
6104 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6105 1.1 skrll if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6106 1.3 christos {
6107 1.3 christos map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
6108 1.3 christos if (section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
6109 1.3 christos lowest_section = section;
6110 1.3 christos if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6111 1.3 christos {
6112 1.3 christos bfd_vma seg_off;
6113 1.3 christos
6114 1.3 christos /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
6115 1.3 christos p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
6116 1.3 christos If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
6117 1.3 christos with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
6118 1.3 christos invalid. */
6119 1.3 christos if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
6120 1.3 christos seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
6121 1.3 christos else
6122 1.3 christos seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
6123 1.3 christos if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
6124 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6125 1.1 skrll }
6126 1.1 skrll if (isec == section_count)
6127 1.1 skrll break;
6128 1.1 skrll }
6129 1.1 skrll }
6130 1.3 christos }
6131 1.3 christos
6132 1.3 christos if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
6133 1.3 christos /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
6134 1.3 christos map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
6135 1.3 christos
6136 1.3 christos if (!map->includes_phdrs
6137 1.3 christos && !map->includes_filehdr
6138 1.3 christos && map->p_paddr_valid)
6139 1.3 christos /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
6140 1.3 christos map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
6141 1.1 skrll - segment->p_paddr);
6142 1.1 skrll
6143 1.1 skrll map->count = section_count;
6144 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
6145 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6146 1.1 skrll }
6147 1.1 skrll
6148 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
6149 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6150 1.1 skrll }
6151 1.1 skrll
6152 1.1 skrll /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
6153 1.1 skrll information. */
6154 1.1 skrll
6155 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6156 1.1 skrll copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6157 1.1 skrll {
6158 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6159 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6160 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6161 1.1 skrll
6162 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
6163 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6164 1.1 skrll
6165 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6166 1.1 skrll {
6167 1.1 skrll /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
6168 1.1 skrll covered by ELF program header have changed. */
6169 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6170 1.1 skrll asection *section, *osec;
6171 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_segments;
6172 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6173 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6174 1.1 skrll
6175 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6176 1.1 skrll
6177 1.1 skrll /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
6178 1.1 skrll if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
6179 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6180 1.1 skrll
6181 1.1 skrll /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
6182 1.1 skrll for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6183 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6184 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6185 1.1 skrll
6186 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6187 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6188 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6189 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6190 1.1 skrll {
6191 1.1 skrll /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
6192 1.1 skrll and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
6193 1.1 skrll which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
6194 1.1 skrll map in this case. */
6195 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr == 0
6196 1.1 skrll && segment->p_memsz == 0
6197 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
6198 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6199 1.1 skrll
6200 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections;
6201 1.1 skrll section != NULL; section = section->next)
6202 1.1 skrll {
6203 1.1 skrll /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
6204 1.1 skrll from the input BFD. */
6205 1.1 skrll osec = section->output_section;
6206 1.1 skrll if (osec)
6207 1.1 skrll osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
6208 1.1 skrll
6209 1.3 christos /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
6210 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6211 1.1 skrll if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6212 1.1 skrll {
6213 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
6214 1.1 skrll removed. What else do we need to check? */
6215 1.1 skrll if (osec == NULL
6216 1.1 skrll || section->flags != osec->flags
6217 1.1 skrll || section->lma != osec->lma
6218 1.1 skrll || section->vma != osec->vma
6219 1.1 skrll || section->size != osec->size
6220 1.1 skrll || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
6221 1.1 skrll || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
6222 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6223 1.1 skrll }
6224 1.1 skrll }
6225 1.1 skrll }
6226 1.1 skrll
6227 1.1 skrll /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
6228 1.1 skrll input BFD. */
6229 1.1 skrll for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6230 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6231 1.1 skrll {
6232 1.1 skrll if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
6233 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6234 1.1 skrll else
6235 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6236 1.1 skrll }
6237 1.1 skrll
6238 1.1 skrll return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6239 1.1 skrll }
6240 1.1 skrll
6241 1.1 skrll rewrite:
6242 1.1 skrll return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6243 1.1 skrll }
6244 1.1 skrll
6245 1.1 skrll /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
6246 1.1 skrll
6247 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6248 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6249 1.1 skrll asection *isec,
6250 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
6251 1.1 skrll asection *osec,
6252 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6253 1.1 skrll
6254 1.3 christos {
6255 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6256 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean final_link = link_info != NULL && !link_info->relocatable;
6257 1.1 skrll
6258 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6259 1.1 skrll || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6260 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6261 1.3 christos
6262 1.3 christos /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
6263 1.3 christos section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
6264 1.1 skrll set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
6265 1.3 christos that the linker clears to differ. */
6266 1.3 christos if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
6267 1.3 christos && (osec->flags == isec->flags
6268 1.3 christos || (final_link
6269 1.1 skrll && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
6270 1.1 skrll & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
6271 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
6272 1.1 skrll
6273 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
6274 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6275 1.1 skrll & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
6276 1.1 skrll
6277 1.1 skrll /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
6278 1.1 skrll SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
6279 1.3 christos to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
6280 1.1 skrll See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
6281 1.1 skrll if (!final_link)
6282 1.1 skrll {
6283 1.1 skrll if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
6284 1.1 skrll || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6285 1.1 skrll {
6286 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
6287 1.2 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
6288 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6289 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
6290 1.1 skrll }
6291 1.1 skrll }
6292 1.1 skrll
6293 1.1 skrll ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6294 1.1 skrll
6295 1.1 skrll /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
6296 1.1 skrll don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
6297 1.1 skrll may be NULL at this point. */
6298 1.1 skrll if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
6299 1.1 skrll {
6300 1.1 skrll ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6301 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
6302 1.1 skrll elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
6303 1.1 skrll }
6304 1.1 skrll
6305 1.1 skrll osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
6306 1.1 skrll
6307 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6308 1.1 skrll }
6309 1.1 skrll
6310 1.1 skrll /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
6311 1.1 skrll field, and sometimes the info field. */
6312 1.1 skrll
6313 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6314 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6315 1.1 skrll asection *isec,
6316 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
6317 1.1 skrll asection *osec)
6318 1.1 skrll {
6319 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6320 1.1 skrll
6321 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6322 1.1 skrll || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6323 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6324 1.1 skrll
6325 1.1 skrll ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6326 1.1 skrll ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6327 1.1 skrll
6328 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
6329 1.1 skrll
6330 1.1 skrll if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
6331 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
6332 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
6333 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
6334 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
6335 1.1 skrll
6336 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
6337 1.1 skrll NULL);
6338 1.3 christos }
6339 1.3 christos
6340 1.3 christos /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
6341 1.3 christos necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
6342 1.3 christos the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
6343 1.3 christos output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
6344 1.1 skrll function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
6345 1.1 skrll from the linker. */
6346 1.3 christos
6347 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6348 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
6349 1.1 skrll {
6350 1.1 skrll asection *isec;
6351 1.3 christos
6352 1.1 skrll for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
6353 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
6354 1.1 skrll {
6355 1.3 christos asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6356 1.3 christos asection *s = first;
6357 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type removed = 0;
6358 1.1 skrll
6359 1.3 christos while (s != NULL)
6360 1.3 christos {
6361 1.3 christos /* If this member section is being output but the
6362 1.3 christos SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
6363 1.3 christos set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
6364 1.1 skrll if (s->output_section != discarded
6365 1.1 skrll && isec->output_section == discarded)
6366 1.1 skrll {
6367 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
6368 1.3 christos elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
6369 1.3 christos }
6370 1.3 christos /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
6371 1.3 christos but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
6372 1.3 christos else if (s->output_section == discarded
6373 1.1 skrll && isec->output_section != discarded)
6374 1.1 skrll removed += 4;
6375 1.1 skrll s = elf_next_in_group (s);
6376 1.1 skrll if (s == first)
6377 1.3 christos break;
6378 1.3 christos }
6379 1.3 christos if (removed != 0)
6380 1.3 christos {
6381 1.3 christos if (discarded != NULL)
6382 1.3 christos {
6383 1.3 christos /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
6384 1.3 christos adjust the input section size. This function may
6385 1.3 christos be called multiple times, so save the original
6386 1.3 christos size. */
6387 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6388 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6389 1.3 christos isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
6390 1.3 christos }
6391 1.3 christos else
6392 1.3 christos {
6393 1.3 christos /* Adjust the output section size when called from
6394 1.3 christos objcopy. */
6395 1.3 christos isec->output_section->size -= removed;
6396 1.1 skrll }
6397 1.1 skrll }
6398 1.1 skrll }
6399 1.1 skrll
6400 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6401 1.3 christos }
6402 1.3 christos
6403 1.3 christos /* Copy private header information. */
6404 1.3 christos
6405 1.3 christos bfd_boolean
6406 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6407 1.3 christos {
6408 1.3 christos if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6409 1.3 christos || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6410 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6411 1.3 christos
6412 1.3 christos /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
6413 1.3 christos This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
6414 1.3 christos entry point, because the latter is called after the section
6415 1.3 christos contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
6416 1.3 christos already been worked out. */
6417 1.3 christos if (elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
6418 1.3 christos {
6419 1.3 christos if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
6420 1.3 christos return FALSE;
6421 1.3 christos }
6422 1.3 christos
6423 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
6424 1.1 skrll }
6425 1.1 skrll
6426 1.1 skrll /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
6427 1.1 skrll which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
6428 1.1 skrll index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
6429 1.1 skrll section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
6430 1.1 skrll swap_out_syms function. */
6431 1.1 skrll
6432 1.1 skrll #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
6433 1.1 skrll #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
6434 1.1 skrll #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
6435 1.1 skrll #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
6436 1.1 skrll #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
6437 1.1 skrll
6438 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6439 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
6440 1.1 skrll asymbol *isymarg,
6441 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
6442 1.1 skrll asymbol *osymarg)
6443 1.1 skrll {
6444 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
6445 1.1 skrll
6446 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6447 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6448 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6449 1.1 skrll
6450 1.1 skrll isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
6451 1.1 skrll osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
6452 1.1 skrll
6453 1.1 skrll if (isym != NULL
6454 1.1 skrll && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
6455 1.1 skrll && osym != NULL
6456 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
6457 1.1 skrll {
6458 1.1 skrll unsigned int shndx;
6459 1.1 skrll
6460 1.1 skrll shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6461 1.1 skrll if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
6462 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
6463 1.1 skrll else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
6464 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
6465 1.1 skrll else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->strtab_section)
6466 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
6467 1.1 skrll else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->shstrtab_section)
6468 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
6469 1.1 skrll else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_section)
6470 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
6471 1.1 skrll osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6472 1.1 skrll }
6473 1.1 skrll
6474 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6475 1.1 skrll }
6476 1.1 skrll
6477 1.1 skrll /* Swap out the symbols. */
6478 1.1 skrll
6479 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6480 1.1 skrll swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
6481 1.1 skrll struct bfd_strtab_hash **sttp,
6482 1.1 skrll int relocatable_p)
6483 1.1 skrll {
6484 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6485 1.1 skrll int symcount;
6486 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms;
6487 1.1 skrll struct bfd_strtab_hash *stt;
6488 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6489 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
6490 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
6491 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
6492 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
6493 1.1 skrll int idx;
6494 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
6495 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
6496 1.1 skrll
6497 1.1 skrll if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd))
6498 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6499 1.1 skrll
6500 1.1 skrll /* Dump out the symtabs. */
6501 1.1 skrll stt = _bfd_elf_stringtab_init ();
6502 1.1 skrll if (stt == NULL)
6503 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6504 1.1 skrll
6505 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6506 1.1 skrll symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
6507 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6508 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
6509 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6510 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
6511 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_info = elf_num_locals (abfd) + 1;
6512 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
6513 1.1 skrll
6514 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
6515 1.3 christos symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6516 1.3 christos
6517 1.1 skrll outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
6518 1.1 skrll bed->s->sizeof_sym);
6519 1.1 skrll if (outbound_syms == NULL)
6520 1.1 skrll {
6521 1.1 skrll _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6522 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6523 1.1 skrll }
6524 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
6525 1.1 skrll
6526 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx = NULL;
6527 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
6528 1.1 skrll if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
6529 1.3 christos {
6530 1.3 christos amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6531 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
6532 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
6533 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
6534 1.1 skrll {
6535 1.1 skrll _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6536 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6537 1.1 skrll }
6538 1.1 skrll
6539 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
6540 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
6541 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
6542 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6543 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6544 1.1 skrll }
6545 1.1 skrll
6546 1.1 skrll /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
6547 1.1 skrll {
6548 1.1 skrll /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
6549 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6550 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = 0;
6551 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = 0;
6552 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = 0;
6553 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = 0;
6554 1.1 skrll sym.st_other = 0;
6555 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
6556 1.1 skrll bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6557 1.1 skrll outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6558 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6559 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6560 1.1 skrll }
6561 1.1 skrll
6562 1.1 skrll name_local_sections
6563 1.1 skrll = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
6564 1.1 skrll && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
6565 1.1 skrll
6566 1.1 skrll syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
6567 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
6568 1.1 skrll {
6569 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6570 1.1 skrll bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
6571 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
6572 1.1 skrll flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
6573 1.1 skrll int type;
6574 1.1 skrll
6575 1.1 skrll if (!name_local_sections
6576 1.1 skrll && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6577 1.1 skrll {
6578 1.1 skrll /* Local section symbols have no name. */
6579 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = 0;
6580 1.1 skrll }
6581 1.1 skrll else
6582 1.1 skrll {
6583 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = (unsigned long) _bfd_stringtab_add (stt,
6584 1.1 skrll syms[idx]->name,
6585 1.1 skrll TRUE, FALSE);
6586 1.1 skrll if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
6587 1.1 skrll {
6588 1.1 skrll _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6589 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6590 1.1 skrll }
6591 1.1 skrll }
6592 1.1 skrll
6593 1.1 skrll type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
6594 1.1 skrll
6595 1.1 skrll if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
6596 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6597 1.1 skrll {
6598 1.1 skrll /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
6599 1.1 skrll and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
6600 1.1 skrll how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
6601 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = value;
6602 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr == NULL
6603 1.1 skrll || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
6604 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
6605 1.1 skrll else
6606 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
6607 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
6608 1.1 skrll (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
6609 1.1 skrll }
6610 1.1 skrll else
6611 1.1 skrll {
6612 1.1 skrll asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
6613 1.1 skrll unsigned int shndx;
6614 1.1 skrll
6615 1.1 skrll if (sec->output_section)
6616 1.1 skrll {
6617 1.1 skrll value += sec->output_offset;
6618 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
6619 1.1 skrll }
6620 1.1 skrll
6621 1.1 skrll /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
6622 1.1 skrll if (! relocatable_p)
6623 1.1 skrll value += sec->vma;
6624 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = value;
6625 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
6626 1.1 skrll
6627 1.1 skrll if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
6628 1.1 skrll && type_ptr != NULL
6629 1.1 skrll && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
6630 1.1 skrll {
6631 1.1 skrll /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
6632 1.1 skrll not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
6633 1.1 skrll by copy_private_symbol_data. */
6634 1.1 skrll shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6635 1.1 skrll switch (shndx)
6636 1.1 skrll {
6637 1.1 skrll case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
6638 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
6639 1.1 skrll break;
6640 1.1 skrll case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
6641 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
6642 1.1 skrll break;
6643 1.1 skrll case MAP_STRTAB:
6644 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_section;
6645 1.1 skrll break;
6646 1.1 skrll case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
6647 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_section;
6648 1.1 skrll break;
6649 1.1 skrll case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
6650 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_section;
6651 1.1 skrll break;
6652 1.1 skrll default:
6653 1.1 skrll break;
6654 1.1 skrll }
6655 1.1 skrll }
6656 1.1 skrll else
6657 1.1 skrll {
6658 1.1 skrll shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
6659 1.1 skrll
6660 1.1 skrll if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
6661 1.1 skrll {
6662 1.1 skrll asection *sec2;
6663 1.1 skrll
6664 1.1 skrll /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
6665 1.1 skrll we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
6666 1.1 skrll knew what to expect of the library, and what to
6667 1.1 skrll demand of applications. For example, it
6668 1.1 skrll appears that `objcopy' might not set the
6669 1.1 skrll section of a symbol to be a section that is
6670 1.1 skrll actually in the output file. */
6671 1.1 skrll sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
6672 1.1 skrll if (sec2 == NULL)
6673 1.1 skrll {
6674 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6675 1.1 skrll Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
6676 1.1 skrll syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
6677 1.1 skrll sec->name);
6678 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6679 1.1 skrll _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6680 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6681 1.1 skrll }
6682 1.1 skrll
6683 1.1 skrll shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
6684 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
6685 1.1 skrll }
6686 1.1 skrll }
6687 1.1 skrll
6688 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6689 1.1 skrll }
6690 1.1 skrll
6691 1.3 christos if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
6692 1.3 christos type = STT_TLS;
6693 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
6694 1.1 skrll type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
6695 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
6696 1.1 skrll type = STT_FUNC;
6697 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
6698 1.1 skrll type = STT_OBJECT;
6699 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
6700 1.1 skrll type = STT_RELC;
6701 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
6702 1.1 skrll type = STT_SRELC;
6703 1.1 skrll else
6704 1.1 skrll type = STT_NOTYPE;
6705 1.1 skrll
6706 1.1 skrll if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
6707 1.1 skrll type = STT_TLS;
6708 1.1 skrll
6709 1.1 skrll /* Processor-specific types. */
6710 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr != NULL
6711 1.1 skrll && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6712 1.1 skrll type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6713 1.1 skrll (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
6714 1.1 skrll
6715 1.1 skrll if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6716 1.1 skrll {
6717 1.1 skrll if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6718 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6719 1.1 skrll else
6720 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
6721 1.1 skrll }
6722 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6723 1.1 skrll {
6724 1.1 skrll #ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
6725 1.1 skrll if (type == STT_OBJECT)
6726 1.3 christos sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
6727 1.1 skrll else
6728 1.1 skrll #endif
6729 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
6730 1.1 skrll }
6731 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
6732 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
6733 1.1 skrll ? STB_WEAK
6734 1.1 skrll : STB_GLOBAL),
6735 1.1 skrll type);
6736 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
6737 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
6738 1.1 skrll else
6739 1.1 skrll {
6740 1.1 skrll int bind = STB_LOCAL;
6741 1.1 skrll
6742 1.3 christos if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
6743 1.3 christos bind = STB_LOCAL;
6744 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
6745 1.1 skrll bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
6746 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
6747 1.1 skrll bind = STB_WEAK;
6748 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6749 1.1 skrll bind = STB_GLOBAL;
6750 1.1 skrll
6751 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
6752 1.1 skrll }
6753 1.1 skrll
6754 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr != NULL)
6755 1.1 skrll sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
6756 1.1 skrll else
6757 1.1 skrll sym.st_other = 0;
6758 1.1 skrll
6759 1.1 skrll bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6760 1.1 skrll outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6761 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6762 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6763 1.1 skrll }
6764 1.1 skrll
6765 1.1 skrll *sttp = stt;
6766 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_stringtab_size (stt);
6767 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6768 1.1 skrll
6769 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
6770 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
6771 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6772 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
6773 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
6774 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
6775 1.1 skrll
6776 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6777 1.1 skrll }
6778 1.1 skrll
6779 1.1 skrll /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
6780 1.1 skrll
6781 1.1 skrll Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
6782 1.1 skrll the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
6783 1.1 skrll always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
6784 1.1 skrll
6785 1.1 skrll long
6786 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6787 1.1 skrll {
6788 1.1 skrll long symcount;
6789 1.1 skrll long symtab_size;
6790 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6791 1.1 skrll
6792 1.1 skrll symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6793 1.1 skrll symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6794 1.1 skrll if (symcount > 0)
6795 1.1 skrll symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6796 1.1 skrll
6797 1.1 skrll return symtab_size;
6798 1.1 skrll }
6799 1.1 skrll
6800 1.1 skrll long
6801 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6802 1.1 skrll {
6803 1.1 skrll long symcount;
6804 1.1 skrll long symtab_size;
6805 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
6806 1.1 skrll
6807 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6808 1.1 skrll {
6809 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6810 1.1 skrll return -1;
6811 1.1 skrll }
6812 1.1 skrll
6813 1.1 skrll symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6814 1.1 skrll symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6815 1.1 skrll if (symcount > 0)
6816 1.1 skrll symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6817 1.1 skrll
6818 1.1 skrll return symtab_size;
6819 1.1 skrll }
6820 1.1 skrll
6821 1.1 skrll long
6822 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6823 1.1 skrll sec_ptr asect)
6824 1.1 skrll {
6825 1.1 skrll return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
6826 1.1 skrll }
6827 1.1 skrll
6828 1.1 skrll /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
6829 1.1 skrll
6830 1.1 skrll long
6831 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
6832 1.1 skrll sec_ptr section,
6833 1.1 skrll arelent **relptr,
6834 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols)
6835 1.1 skrll {
6836 1.1 skrll arelent *tblptr;
6837 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6838 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6839 1.1 skrll
6840 1.1 skrll if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
6841 1.1 skrll return -1;
6842 1.1 skrll
6843 1.1 skrll tblptr = section->relocation;
6844 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
6845 1.1 skrll *relptr++ = tblptr++;
6846 1.1 skrll
6847 1.1 skrll *relptr = NULL;
6848 1.1 skrll
6849 1.1 skrll return section->reloc_count;
6850 1.1 skrll }
6851 1.1 skrll
6852 1.1 skrll long
6853 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
6854 1.1 skrll {
6855 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6856 1.1 skrll long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
6857 1.1 skrll
6858 1.1 skrll if (symcount >= 0)
6859 1.1 skrll bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
6860 1.1 skrll return symcount;
6861 1.1 skrll }
6862 1.1 skrll
6863 1.1 skrll long
6864 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
6865 1.1 skrll asymbol **allocation)
6866 1.1 skrll {
6867 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6868 1.1 skrll long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
6869 1.1 skrll
6870 1.1 skrll if (symcount >= 0)
6871 1.1 skrll bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
6872 1.1 skrll return symcount;
6873 1.1 skrll }
6874 1.1 skrll
6875 1.1 skrll /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
6876 1.1 skrll section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
6877 1.1 skrll or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
6878 1.1 skrll dynamic reloc section. */
6879 1.1 skrll
6880 1.1 skrll long
6881 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6882 1.1 skrll {
6883 1.1 skrll long ret;
6884 1.1 skrll asection *s;
6885 1.1 skrll
6886 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6887 1.1 skrll {
6888 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6889 1.1 skrll return -1;
6890 1.1 skrll }
6891 1.1 skrll
6892 1.1 skrll ret = sizeof (arelent *);
6893 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6894 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
6895 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
6896 1.1 skrll || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
6897 1.1 skrll ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
6898 1.1 skrll * sizeof (arelent *));
6899 1.1 skrll
6900 1.1 skrll return ret;
6901 1.1 skrll }
6902 1.1 skrll
6903 1.1 skrll /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
6904 1.1 skrll dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
6905 1.1 skrll associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
6906 1.1 skrll designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
6907 1.1 skrll one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
6908 1.1 skrll installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
6909 1.1 skrll dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
6910 1.1 skrll
6911 1.1 skrll long
6912 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
6913 1.1 skrll arelent **storage,
6914 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms)
6915 1.1 skrll {
6916 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
6917 1.1 skrll asection *s;
6918 1.1 skrll long ret;
6919 1.1 skrll
6920 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6921 1.1 skrll {
6922 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6923 1.1 skrll return -1;
6924 1.1 skrll }
6925 1.1 skrll
6926 1.1 skrll slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
6927 1.1 skrll ret = 0;
6928 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6929 1.1 skrll {
6930 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
6931 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
6932 1.1 skrll || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
6933 1.1 skrll {
6934 1.1 skrll arelent *p;
6935 1.1 skrll long count, i;
6936 1.1 skrll
6937 1.1 skrll if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
6938 1.1 skrll return -1;
6939 1.1 skrll count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
6940 1.1 skrll p = s->relocation;
6941 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
6942 1.1 skrll *storage++ = p++;
6943 1.1 skrll ret += count;
6944 1.1 skrll }
6945 1.1 skrll }
6946 1.1 skrll
6947 1.1 skrll *storage = NULL;
6948 1.1 skrll
6949 1.1 skrll return ret;
6950 1.1 skrll }
6951 1.1 skrll
6952 1.1 skrll /* Read in the version information. */
6954 1.1 skrll
6955 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6956 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
6957 1.1 skrll {
6958 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6959 1.1 skrll unsigned int freeidx = 0;
6960 1.1 skrll
6961 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
6962 1.1 skrll {
6963 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6964 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
6965 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
6966 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6967 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents_end;
6968 1.3 christos
6969 1.3 christos hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
6970 1.1 skrll
6971 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
6972 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
6973 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
6974 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
6975 1.3 christos
6976 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = hdr->sh_info;
6977 1.1 skrll
6978 1.1 skrll contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
6979 1.1 skrll if (contents == NULL)
6980 1.1 skrll {
6981 1.1 skrll error_return_verref:
6982 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
6983 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
6984 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
6985 1.1 skrll }
6986 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6987 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
6988 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
6989 1.1 skrll
6990 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
6991 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
6992 1.1 skrll
6993 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
6994 1.1 skrll == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
6995 1.1 skrll contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
6996 1.1 skrll everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
6997 1.1 skrll iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
6998 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
6999 1.1 skrll {
7000 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
7001 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
7002 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
7003 1.1 skrll
7004 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
7005 1.1 skrll
7006 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
7007 1.1 skrll
7008 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_filename =
7009 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7010 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_file);
7011 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
7012 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7013 1.1 skrll
7014 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
7015 1.3 christos iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
7016 1.3 christos else
7017 1.3 christos {
7018 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
7019 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
7020 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
7021 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
7022 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7023 1.1 skrll }
7024 1.1 skrll
7025 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_aux
7026 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7027 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7028 1.1 skrll
7029 1.1 skrll evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7030 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
7031 1.1 skrll ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
7032 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
7033 1.1 skrll {
7034 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
7035 1.1 skrll
7036 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nodename =
7037 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7038 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_name);
7039 1.1 skrll if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
7040 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7041 1.1 skrll
7042 1.1 skrll if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
7043 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
7044 1.1 skrll else
7045 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
7046 1.1 skrll
7047 1.1 skrll if (ivernaux->vna_next
7048 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
7049 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7050 1.1 skrll
7051 1.1 skrll evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7052 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
7053 1.1 skrll
7054 1.1 skrll if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
7055 1.1 skrll freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
7056 1.1 skrll }
7057 1.1 skrll
7058 1.1 skrll if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
7059 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
7060 1.1 skrll else
7061 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
7062 1.1 skrll
7063 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_next
7064 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7065 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7066 1.1 skrll
7067 1.1 skrll everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
7068 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
7069 1.1 skrll }
7070 1.1 skrll
7071 1.1 skrll free (contents);
7072 1.1 skrll contents = NULL;
7073 1.1 skrll }
7074 1.1 skrll
7075 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
7076 1.1 skrll {
7077 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7078 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
7079 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7080 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
7081 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
7082 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
7083 1.1 skrll unsigned int maxidx;
7084 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
7085 1.3 christos
7086 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
7087 1.1 skrll
7088 1.1 skrll contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7089 1.1 skrll if (contents == NULL)
7090 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7091 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7092 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7093 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7094 1.1 skrll
7095 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
7096 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7097 1.1 skrll
7098 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
7099 1.1 skrll >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
7100 1.1 skrll contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
7101 1.1 skrll - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
7102 1.1 skrll contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
7103 1.1 skrll - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
7104 1.1 skrll
7105 1.1 skrll /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
7106 1.1 skrll index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
7107 1.1 skrll the maximum. */
7108 1.1 skrll everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7109 1.1 skrll maxidx = 0;
7110 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
7111 1.1 skrll {
7112 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7113 1.1 skrll
7114 1.1 skrll if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
7115 1.1 skrll maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
7116 1.1 skrll
7117 1.1 skrll if (iverdefmem.vd_next
7118 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7119 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7120 1.1 skrll
7121 1.1 skrll everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7122 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
7123 1.1 skrll }
7124 1.1 skrll
7125 1.1 skrll if (default_imported_symver)
7126 1.1 skrll {
7127 1.1 skrll if (freeidx > maxidx)
7128 1.1 skrll maxidx = ++freeidx;
7129 1.3 christos else
7130 1.3 christos freeidx = ++maxidx;
7131 1.1 skrll }
7132 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7133 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7134 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7135 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7136 1.1 skrll
7137 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
7138 1.1 skrll
7139 1.1 skrll everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7140 1.1 skrll iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
7141 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
7142 1.1 skrll {
7143 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
7144 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7145 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
7146 1.1 skrll
7147 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7148 1.1 skrll
7149 1.1 skrll if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
7150 1.1 skrll {
7151 1.1 skrll error_return_verdef:
7152 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
7153 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
7154 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7155 1.1 skrll }
7156 1.1 skrll
7157 1.1 skrll iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
7158 1.1 skrll memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7159 1.1 skrll
7160 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7161 1.1 skrll
7162 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
7163 1.3 christos iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
7164 1.3 christos else
7165 1.3 christos {
7166 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7167 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
7168 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7169 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7170 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7171 1.1 skrll }
7172 1.1 skrll
7173 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_aux
7174 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7175 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7176 1.1 skrll
7177 1.1 skrll everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7178 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
7179 1.1 skrll iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7180 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
7181 1.1 skrll {
7182 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
7183 1.1 skrll
7184 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nodename =
7185 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7186 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_name);
7187 1.1 skrll if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
7188 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7189 1.1 skrll
7190 1.1 skrll if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
7191 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
7192 1.1 skrll else
7193 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7194 1.1 skrll
7195 1.1 skrll if (iverdaux->vda_next
7196 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
7197 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7198 1.1 skrll
7199 1.1 skrll everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7200 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
7201 1.1 skrll }
7202 1.1 skrll
7203 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
7204 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
7205 1.1 skrll
7206 1.1 skrll if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
7207 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
7208 1.1 skrll else
7209 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7210 1.1 skrll
7211 1.1 skrll everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7212 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
7213 1.1 skrll }
7214 1.1 skrll
7215 1.1 skrll free (contents);
7216 1.1 skrll contents = NULL;
7217 1.1 skrll }
7218 1.1 skrll else if (default_imported_symver)
7219 1.1 skrll {
7220 1.1 skrll if (freeidx < 3)
7221 1.1 skrll freeidx = 3;
7222 1.3 christos else
7223 1.3 christos freeidx++;
7224 1.1 skrll
7225 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7226 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7227 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7228 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7229 1.1 skrll
7230 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
7231 1.1 skrll }
7232 1.1 skrll
7233 1.1 skrll /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
7234 1.1 skrll if (default_imported_symver)
7235 1.1 skrll {
7236 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7237 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7238 1.1 skrll
7239 1.1 skrll iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];;
7240 1.1 skrll
7241 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
7242 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
7243 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
7244 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
7245 1.1 skrll
7246 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7247 1.1 skrll
7248 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
7249 1.3 christos if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
7250 1.3 christos goto error_return_verdef;
7251 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7252 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7253 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7254 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7255 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7256 1.1 skrll
7257 1.1 skrll iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7258 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
7259 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7260 1.1 skrll }
7261 1.1 skrll
7262 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7263 1.1 skrll
7264 1.1 skrll error_return:
7265 1.1 skrll if (contents != NULL)
7266 1.1 skrll free (contents);
7267 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7268 1.1 skrll }
7269 1.1 skrll
7270 1.1 skrll asymbol *
7272 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
7273 1.3 christos {
7274 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *newsym;
7275 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (elf_symbol_type);
7276 1.1 skrll
7277 1.1 skrll newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7278 1.1 skrll if (!newsym)
7279 1.1 skrll return NULL;
7280 1.1 skrll else
7281 1.1 skrll {
7282 1.1 skrll newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
7283 1.1 skrll return &newsym->symbol;
7284 1.1 skrll }
7285 1.1 skrll }
7286 1.1 skrll
7287 1.1 skrll void
7288 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7289 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
7290 1.1 skrll symbol_info *ret)
7291 1.1 skrll {
7292 1.1 skrll bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
7293 1.1 skrll }
7294 1.1 skrll
7295 1.1 skrll /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
7296 1.1 skrll use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
7297 1.1 skrll override it. */
7298 1.1 skrll
7299 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7300 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7301 1.1 skrll const char *name)
7302 1.1 skrll {
7303 1.1 skrll /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
7304 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
7305 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7306 1.1 skrll
7307 1.1 skrll /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
7308 1.1 skrll DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
7309 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
7310 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7311 1.1 skrll
7312 1.1 skrll /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
7313 1.1 skrll emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
7314 1.1 skrll small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
7315 1.1 skrll ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
7316 1.1 skrll underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
7317 1.1 skrll we treat such symbols as local. */
7318 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
7319 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7320 1.1 skrll
7321 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7322 1.1 skrll }
7323 1.1 skrll
7324 1.1 skrll alent *
7325 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7326 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7327 1.1 skrll {
7328 1.1 skrll abort ();
7329 1.1 skrll return NULL;
7330 1.1 skrll }
7331 1.1 skrll
7332 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7333 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
7334 1.1 skrll enum bfd_architecture arch,
7335 1.1 skrll unsigned long machine)
7336 1.1 skrll {
7337 1.1 skrll /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
7338 1.1 skrll isn't the generic backend, fail. */
7339 1.1 skrll if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
7340 1.1 skrll && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
7341 1.1 skrll && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
7342 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7343 1.1 skrll
7344 1.1 skrll return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
7345 1.1 skrll }
7346 1.1 skrll
7347 1.3 christos /* Find the function to a particular section and offset,
7348 1.1 skrll for error reporting. */
7349 1.1 skrll
7350 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7351 1.1 skrll elf_find_function (bfd *abfd,
7352 1.1 skrll asection *section,
7353 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols,
7354 1.1 skrll bfd_vma offset,
7355 1.1 skrll const char **filename_ptr,
7356 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr)
7357 1.1 skrll {
7358 1.1 skrll const char *filename;
7359 1.1 skrll asymbol *func, *file;
7360 1.1 skrll bfd_vma low_func;
7361 1.1 skrll asymbol **p;
7362 1.1 skrll /* ??? Given multiple file symbols, it is impossible to reliably
7363 1.1 skrll choose the right file name for global symbols. File symbols are
7364 1.1 skrll local symbols, and thus all file symbols must sort before any
7365 1.1 skrll global symbols. The ELF spec may be interpreted to say that a
7366 1.1 skrll file symbol must sort before other local symbols, but currently
7367 1.3 christos ld -r doesn't do this. So, for ld -r output, it is possible to
7368 1.1 skrll make a better choice of file name for local symbols by ignoring
7369 1.1 skrll file symbols appearing after a given local symbol. */
7370 1.1 skrll enum { nothing_seen, symbol_seen, file_after_symbol_seen } state;
7371 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7372 1.1 skrll
7373 1.1 skrll filename = NULL;
7374 1.1 skrll func = NULL;
7375 1.1 skrll file = NULL;
7376 1.1 skrll low_func = 0;
7377 1.1 skrll state = nothing_seen;
7378 1.3 christos
7379 1.1 skrll for (p = symbols; *p != NULL; p++)
7380 1.1 skrll {
7381 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *q;
7382 1.3 christos unsigned int type;
7383 1.3 christos
7384 1.1 skrll q = (elf_symbol_type *) *p;
7385 1.1 skrll
7386 1.1 skrll type = ELF_ST_TYPE (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info);
7387 1.1 skrll switch (type)
7388 1.1 skrll {
7389 1.1 skrll case STT_FILE:
7390 1.3 christos file = &q->symbol;
7391 1.3 christos if (state == symbol_seen)
7392 1.3 christos state = file_after_symbol_seen;
7393 1.1 skrll continue;
7394 1.1 skrll default:
7395 1.1 skrll if (!bed->is_function_type (type))
7396 1.1 skrll break;
7397 1.1 skrll case STT_NOTYPE:
7398 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_section (&q->symbol) == section
7399 1.1 skrll && q->symbol.value >= low_func
7400 1.1 skrll && q->symbol.value <= offset)
7401 1.1 skrll {
7402 1.1 skrll func = (asymbol *) q;
7403 1.1 skrll low_func = q->symbol.value;
7404 1.1 skrll filename = NULL;
7405 1.1 skrll if (file != NULL
7406 1.1 skrll && (ELF_ST_BIND (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STB_LOCAL
7407 1.1 skrll || state != file_after_symbol_seen))
7408 1.1 skrll filename = bfd_asymbol_name (file);
7409 1.1 skrll }
7410 1.1 skrll break;
7411 1.1 skrll }
7412 1.1 skrll if (state == nothing_seen)
7413 1.1 skrll state = symbol_seen;
7414 1.1 skrll }
7415 1.1 skrll
7416 1.1 skrll if (func == NULL)
7417 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7418 1.1 skrll
7419 1.1 skrll if (filename_ptr)
7420 1.1 skrll *filename_ptr = filename;
7421 1.1 skrll if (functionname_ptr)
7422 1.1 skrll *functionname_ptr = bfd_asymbol_name (func);
7423 1.1 skrll
7424 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7425 1.1 skrll }
7426 1.1 skrll
7427 1.1 skrll /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
7428 1.1 skrll for error reporting. */
7429 1.1 skrll
7430 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7431 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
7432 1.1 skrll asection *section,
7433 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols,
7434 1.1 skrll bfd_vma offset,
7435 1.1 skrll const char **filename_ptr,
7436 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr,
7437 1.1 skrll unsigned int *line_ptr)
7438 1.1 skrll {
7439 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean found;
7440 1.1 skrll
7441 1.1 skrll if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7442 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7443 1.1 skrll line_ptr))
7444 1.1 skrll {
7445 1.1 skrll if (!*functionname_ptr)
7446 1.1 skrll elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7447 1.1 skrll *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7448 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr);
7449 1.1 skrll
7450 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7451 1.1 skrll }
7452 1.1 skrll
7453 1.1 skrll if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7454 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7455 1.1 skrll line_ptr, 0,
7456 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
7457 1.1 skrll {
7458 1.1 skrll if (!*functionname_ptr)
7459 1.1 skrll elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7460 1.1 skrll *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7461 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr);
7462 1.1 skrll
7463 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7464 1.1 skrll }
7465 1.1 skrll
7466 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
7467 1.1 skrll &found, filename_ptr,
7468 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7469 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
7470 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7471 1.1 skrll if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
7472 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7473 1.1 skrll
7474 1.1 skrll if (symbols == NULL)
7475 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7476 1.1 skrll
7477 1.1 skrll if (! elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7478 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
7479 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7480 1.1 skrll
7481 1.1 skrll *line_ptr = 0;
7482 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7483 1.1 skrll }
7484 1.1 skrll
7485 1.1 skrll /* Find the line for a symbol. */
7486 1.1 skrll
7487 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7488 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
7489 1.1 skrll const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
7490 1.1 skrll {
7491 1.1 skrll return _bfd_dwarf2_find_line (abfd, symbols, symbol,
7492 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, line_ptr, 0,
7493 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7494 1.1 skrll }
7495 1.1 skrll
7496 1.1 skrll /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
7497 1.1 skrll bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
7498 1.1 skrll each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
7499 1.1 skrll passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
7500 1.1 skrll for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
7501 1.1 skrll
7502 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7503 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
7504 1.1 skrll const char **filename_ptr,
7505 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr,
7506 1.1 skrll unsigned int *line_ptr)
7507 1.1 skrll {
7508 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean found;
7509 1.1 skrll found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
7510 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7511 1.1 skrll & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7512 1.1 skrll return found;
7513 1.1 skrll }
7514 1.1 skrll
7515 1.1 skrll int
7516 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7517 1.1 skrll {
7518 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7519 1.1 skrll int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
7520 1.1 skrll
7521 1.1 skrll if (!info->relocatable)
7522 1.1 skrll {
7523 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
7524 1.1 skrll
7525 1.1 skrll if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
7526 1.1 skrll {
7527 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
7528 1.1 skrll
7529 1.1 skrll phdr_size = 0;
7530 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
7531 1.1 skrll phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
7532 1.1 skrll
7533 1.1 skrll if (phdr_size == 0)
7534 1.1 skrll phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
7535 1.1 skrll }
7536 1.1 skrll
7537 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = phdr_size;
7538 1.1 skrll ret += phdr_size;
7539 1.1 skrll }
7540 1.1 skrll
7541 1.1 skrll return ret;
7542 1.1 skrll }
7543 1.1 skrll
7544 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7545 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
7546 1.1 skrll sec_ptr section,
7547 1.1 skrll const void *location,
7548 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset,
7549 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type count)
7550 1.1 skrll {
7551 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7552 1.1 skrll bfd_signed_vma pos;
7553 1.1 skrll
7554 1.1 skrll if (! abfd->output_has_begun
7555 1.1 skrll && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
7556 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7557 1.1 skrll
7558 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
7559 1.1 skrll pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
7560 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
7561 1.1 skrll || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
7562 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7563 1.1 skrll
7564 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7565 1.1 skrll }
7566 1.1 skrll
7567 1.1 skrll void
7568 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7569 1.1 skrll arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7570 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7571 1.1 skrll {
7572 1.1 skrll abort ();
7573 1.1 skrll }
7574 1.1 skrll
7575 1.1 skrll /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
7576 1.1 skrll
7577 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7578 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
7579 1.1 skrll {
7580 1.1 skrll /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
7581 1.1 skrll
7582 1.1 skrll if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
7583 1.1 skrll {
7584 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
7585 1.1 skrll reloc_howto_type *howto;
7586 1.1 skrll
7587 1.1 skrll /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
7588 1.1 skrll equivalent ELF reloc. */
7589 1.1 skrll
7590 1.1 skrll if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
7591 1.1 skrll {
7592 1.1 skrll switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7593 1.1 skrll {
7594 1.1 skrll case 8:
7595 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
7596 1.1 skrll break;
7597 1.1 skrll case 12:
7598 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
7599 1.1 skrll break;
7600 1.1 skrll case 16:
7601 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
7602 1.1 skrll break;
7603 1.1 skrll case 24:
7604 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
7605 1.1 skrll break;
7606 1.1 skrll case 32:
7607 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
7608 1.1 skrll break;
7609 1.1 skrll case 64:
7610 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
7611 1.1 skrll break;
7612 1.1 skrll default:
7613 1.1 skrll goto fail;
7614 1.1 skrll }
7615 1.1 skrll
7616 1.1 skrll howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7617 1.1 skrll
7618 1.1 skrll if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
7619 1.1 skrll {
7620 1.1 skrll if (howto->pcrel_offset)
7621 1.1 skrll areloc->addend += areloc->address;
7622 1.1 skrll else
7623 1.1 skrll areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
7624 1.1 skrll }
7625 1.1 skrll }
7626 1.1 skrll else
7627 1.1 skrll {
7628 1.1 skrll switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7629 1.1 skrll {
7630 1.1 skrll case 8:
7631 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_8;
7632 1.1 skrll break;
7633 1.1 skrll case 14:
7634 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_14;
7635 1.1 skrll break;
7636 1.1 skrll case 16:
7637 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_16;
7638 1.1 skrll break;
7639 1.1 skrll case 26:
7640 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_26;
7641 1.1 skrll break;
7642 1.1 skrll case 32:
7643 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_32;
7644 1.1 skrll break;
7645 1.1 skrll case 64:
7646 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_64;
7647 1.1 skrll break;
7648 1.1 skrll default:
7649 1.1 skrll goto fail;
7650 1.1 skrll }
7651 1.1 skrll
7652 1.1 skrll howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7653 1.1 skrll }
7654 1.1 skrll
7655 1.1 skrll if (howto)
7656 1.1 skrll areloc->howto = howto;
7657 1.1 skrll else
7658 1.1 skrll goto fail;
7659 1.1 skrll }
7660 1.1 skrll
7661 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7662 1.1 skrll
7663 1.1 skrll fail:
7664 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
7665 1.1 skrll (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
7666 1.1 skrll abfd, areloc->howto->name);
7667 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7668 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7669 1.1 skrll }
7670 1.1 skrll
7671 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7672 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
7673 1.1 skrll {
7674 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
7675 1.1 skrll {
7676 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd) != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
7677 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
7678 1.1 skrll _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd);
7679 1.1 skrll }
7680 1.1 skrll
7681 1.1 skrll return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
7682 1.1 skrll }
7683 1.1 skrll
7684 1.1 skrll /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
7685 1.1 skrll in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
7686 1.1 skrll range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
7687 1.1 skrll this reloc. */
7688 1.1 skrll
7689 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
7690 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
7691 1.1 skrll (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7692 1.1 skrll struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7693 1.1 skrll void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7694 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7695 1.1 skrll {
7696 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_ok;
7697 1.1 skrll }
7698 1.1 skrll
7699 1.1 skrll /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
7701 1.3 christos toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
7702 1.3 christos machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
7703 1.1 skrll out details about the corefile. */
7704 1.1 skrll
7705 1.1 skrll #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
7706 1.3 christos /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
7707 1.3 christos # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
7708 1.1 skrll # include <sys/procfs.h>
7709 1.1 skrll #endif
7710 1.1 skrll
7711 1.1 skrll /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
7712 1.3 christos PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
7713 1.3 christos
7714 1.3 christos static int
7715 1.3 christos elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
7716 1.3 christos {
7717 1.3 christos int pid;
7718 1.3 christos
7719 1.1 skrll pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid;
7720 1.1 skrll if (pid == 0)
7721 1.1 skrll pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid;
7722 1.1 skrll
7723 1.1 skrll return pid;
7724 1.1 skrll }
7725 1.1 skrll
7726 1.1 skrll /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
7727 1.1 skrll data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
7728 1.1 skrll reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
7729 1.1 skrll overwrite it. */
7730 1.1 skrll
7731 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7732 1.1 skrll elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
7733 1.1 skrll {
7734 1.1 skrll asection *sect2;
7735 1.1 skrll
7736 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
7737 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7738 1.1 skrll
7739 1.1 skrll sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
7740 1.1 skrll if (sect2 == NULL)
7741 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7742 1.1 skrll
7743 1.1 skrll sect2->size = sect->size;
7744 1.1 skrll sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
7745 1.1 skrll sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
7746 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7747 1.1 skrll }
7748 1.1 skrll
7749 1.1 skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
7750 1.1 skrll actually creates up to two pseudosections:
7751 1.1 skrll - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
7752 1.1 skrll such a section already exists.
7753 1.1 skrll - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
7754 1.1 skrll PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
7755 1.1 skrll Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
7756 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7757 1.1 skrll _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7758 1.1 skrll char *name,
7759 1.1 skrll size_t size,
7760 1.1 skrll ufile_ptr filepos)
7761 1.1 skrll {
7762 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
7763 1.1 skrll char *threaded_name;
7764 1.1 skrll size_t len;
7765 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
7766 1.3 christos
7767 1.1 skrll /* Build the section name. */
7768 1.1 skrll
7769 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
7770 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7771 1.1 skrll threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7772 1.1 skrll if (threaded_name == NULL)
7773 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7774 1.1 skrll memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
7775 1.1 skrll
7776 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
7777 1.1 skrll SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7778 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
7779 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7780 1.1 skrll sect->size = size;
7781 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = filepos;
7782 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
7783 1.1 skrll
7784 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
7785 1.1 skrll }
7786 1.1 skrll
7787 1.1 skrll /* prstatus_t exists on:
7788 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
7789 1.1 skrll linux 2.[01] + glibc
7790 1.1 skrll unixware 4.2
7791 1.1 skrll */
7792 1.1 skrll
7793 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
7794 1.1 skrll
7795 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7796 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7797 1.1 skrll {
7798 1.1 skrll size_t size;
7799 1.1 skrll int offset;
7800 1.1 skrll
7801 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
7802 1.1 skrll {
7803 1.1 skrll prstatus_t prstat;
7804 1.1 skrll
7805 1.1 skrll size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
7806 1.1 skrll offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
7807 1.1 skrll memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
7808 1.3 christos
7809 1.3 christos /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
7810 1.1 skrll has already been set by another thread. */
7811 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
7812 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
7813 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid == 0)
7814 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
7815 1.1 skrll
7816 1.1 skrll /* pr_who exists on:
7817 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
7818 1.1 skrll unixware 4.2
7819 1.3 christos pr_who doesn't exist on:
7820 1.3 christos linux 2.[01]
7821 1.1 skrll */
7822 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
7823 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
7824 1.1 skrll #else
7825 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
7826 1.1 skrll #endif
7827 1.1 skrll }
7828 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
7829 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
7830 1.1 skrll {
7831 1.1 skrll /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
7832 1.1 skrll prstatus32_t prstat;
7833 1.1 skrll
7834 1.1 skrll size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
7835 1.1 skrll offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
7836 1.1 skrll memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
7837 1.3 christos
7838 1.3 christos /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
7839 1.1 skrll has already been set by another thread. */
7840 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
7841 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
7842 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid == 0)
7843 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
7844 1.1 skrll
7845 1.1 skrll /* pr_who exists on:
7846 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
7847 1.1 skrll unixware 4.2
7848 1.3 christos pr_who doesn't exist on:
7849 1.3 christos linux 2.[01]
7850 1.1 skrll */
7851 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
7852 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
7853 1.1 skrll #else
7854 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
7855 1.1 skrll #endif
7856 1.1 skrll }
7857 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
7858 1.1 skrll else
7859 1.1 skrll {
7860 1.1 skrll /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
7861 1.1 skrll note size (ie. data object type). */
7862 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7863 1.1 skrll }
7864 1.1 skrll
7865 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
7866 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
7867 1.1 skrll size, note->descpos + offset);
7868 1.1 skrll }
7869 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
7870 1.1 skrll
7871 1.1 skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
7872 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7873 1.1 skrll elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7874 1.1 skrll char *name,
7875 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7876 1.1 skrll {
7877 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
7878 1.1 skrll note->descsz, note->descpos);
7879 1.1 skrll }
7880 1.1 skrll
7881 1.1 skrll /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
7882 1.1 skrll but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
7883 1.1 skrll data structure apart. */
7884 1.1 skrll
7885 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7886 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7887 1.1 skrll {
7888 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
7889 1.1 skrll }
7890 1.1 skrll
7891 1.1 skrll /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
7892 1.1 skrll type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
7893 1.1 skrll literally. */
7894 1.1 skrll
7895 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7896 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7897 1.3 christos {
7898 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
7899 1.3 christos }
7900 1.3 christos
7901 1.3 christos /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
7902 1.3 christos with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
7903 1.3 christos contents literally. */
7904 1.3 christos
7905 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7906 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7907 1.1 skrll {
7908 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
7909 1.1 skrll }
7910 1.1 skrll
7911 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7912 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7913 1.1 skrll {
7914 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
7915 1.1 skrll }
7916 1.1 skrll
7917 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7918 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7919 1.3 christos {
7920 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
7921 1.3 christos }
7922 1.3 christos
7923 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7924 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7925 1.3 christos {
7926 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
7927 1.3 christos }
7928 1.3 christos
7929 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7930 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7931 1.3 christos {
7932 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
7933 1.3 christos }
7934 1.3 christos
7935 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7936 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7937 1.3 christos {
7938 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
7939 1.3 christos }
7940 1.3 christos
7941 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7942 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7943 1.3 christos {
7944 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
7945 1.3 christos }
7946 1.3 christos
7947 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7948 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7949 1.3 christos {
7950 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
7951 1.3 christos }
7952 1.3 christos
7953 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
7954 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7955 1.1 skrll {
7956 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
7957 1.1 skrll }
7958 1.1 skrll
7959 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
7960 1.1 skrll typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
7961 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
7962 1.1 skrll typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
7963 1.1 skrll #endif
7964 1.1 skrll #endif
7965 1.1 skrll
7966 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
7967 1.1 skrll typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
7968 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
7969 1.1 skrll typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
7970 1.1 skrll #endif
7971 1.1 skrll #endif
7972 1.1 skrll
7973 1.1 skrll /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
7974 1.1 skrll most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
7975 1.1 skrll the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
7976 1.3 christos
7977 1.1 skrll char *
7978 1.1 skrll _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
7979 1.1 skrll {
7980 1.1 skrll char *dups;
7981 1.1 skrll char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
7982 1.1 skrll size_t len;
7983 1.1 skrll
7984 1.3 christos if (end == NULL)
7985 1.1 skrll len = max;
7986 1.1 skrll else
7987 1.1 skrll len = end - start;
7988 1.1 skrll
7989 1.1 skrll dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
7990 1.1 skrll if (dups == NULL)
7991 1.1 skrll return NULL;
7992 1.1 skrll
7993 1.1 skrll memcpy (dups, start, len);
7994 1.1 skrll dups[len] = '\0';
7995 1.1 skrll
7996 1.1 skrll return dups;
7997 1.1 skrll }
7998 1.1 skrll
7999 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8000 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8001 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8002 1.1 skrll {
8003 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
8004 1.3 christos {
8005 1.3 christos elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
8006 1.3 christos
8007 1.1 skrll memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8008 1.1 skrll
8009 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
8010 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8011 1.1 skrll #endif
8012 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
8013 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8014 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8015 1.1 skrll
8016 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8017 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8018 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8019 1.1 skrll }
8020 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8021 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
8022 1.1 skrll {
8023 1.3 christos /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8024 1.3 christos elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
8025 1.3 christos
8026 1.1 skrll memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8027 1.1 skrll
8028 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
8029 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8030 1.1 skrll #endif
8031 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
8032 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8033 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8034 1.1 skrll
8035 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8036 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8037 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8038 1.1 skrll }
8039 1.1 skrll #endif
8040 1.1 skrll
8041 1.1 skrll else
8042 1.1 skrll {
8043 1.1 skrll /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8044 1.1 skrll note size (ie. data object type). */
8045 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8046 1.1 skrll }
8047 1.1 skrll
8048 1.1 skrll /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
8049 1.1 skrll onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
8050 1.1 skrll implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
8051 1.1 skrll
8052 1.1 skrll {
8053 1.1 skrll char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
8054 1.1 skrll int n = strlen (command);
8055 1.1 skrll
8056 1.1 skrll if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
8057 1.1 skrll command[n - 1] = '\0';
8058 1.1 skrll }
8059 1.1 skrll
8060 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8061 1.1 skrll }
8062 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
8063 1.1 skrll
8064 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8065 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8066 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8067 1.1 skrll {
8068 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
8069 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
8070 1.1 skrll || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
8071 1.1 skrll #endif
8072 1.1 skrll )
8073 1.1 skrll {
8074 1.1 skrll pstatus_t pstat;
8075 1.1 skrll
8076 1.1 skrll memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8077 1.1 skrll
8078 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8079 1.1 skrll }
8080 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8081 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
8082 1.1 skrll {
8083 1.1 skrll /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8084 1.1 skrll pstatus32_t pstat;
8085 1.1 skrll
8086 1.1 skrll memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8087 1.1 skrll
8088 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8089 1.1 skrll }
8090 1.1 skrll #endif
8091 1.1 skrll /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
8092 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
8093 1.1 skrll NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
8094 1.1 skrll
8095 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8096 1.1 skrll }
8097 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
8098 1.1 skrll
8099 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8100 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8101 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8102 1.1 skrll {
8103 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8104 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
8105 1.1 skrll char *name;
8106 1.1 skrll size_t len;
8107 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
8108 1.1 skrll
8109 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
8110 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
8111 1.1 skrll && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
8112 1.1 skrll #endif
8113 1.1 skrll )
8114 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8115 1.3 christos
8116 1.3 christos memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
8117 1.3 christos
8118 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
8119 1.1 skrll /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
8120 1.1 skrll another thread. */
8121 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
8122 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
8123 1.1 skrll
8124 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8125 1.1 skrll
8126 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8127 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8128 1.1 skrll name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8129 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8130 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8131 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
8132 1.1 skrll
8133 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8134 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8135 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8136 1.1 skrll
8137 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8138 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8139 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos
8140 1.1 skrll + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8141 1.1 skrll #endif
8142 1.1 skrll
8143 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8144 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
8145 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
8146 1.1 skrll #endif
8147 1.1 skrll
8148 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8149 1.1 skrll
8150 1.1 skrll if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8151 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8152 1.1 skrll
8153 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
8154 1.1 skrll
8155 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8156 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8157 1.1 skrll name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8158 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8159 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8160 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
8161 1.1 skrll
8162 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8163 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8164 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8165 1.1 skrll
8166 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8167 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8168 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos
8169 1.1 skrll + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8170 1.1 skrll #endif
8171 1.1 skrll
8172 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
8173 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
8174 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
8175 1.1 skrll #endif
8176 1.1 skrll
8177 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8178 1.1 skrll
8179 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
8180 1.1 skrll }
8181 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
8182 1.1 skrll
8183 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8184 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8185 1.1 skrll {
8186 1.1 skrll char buf[30];
8187 1.1 skrll char *name;
8188 1.1 skrll size_t len;
8189 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
8190 1.1 skrll int type;
8191 1.1 skrll int is_active_thread;
8192 1.1 skrll bfd_vma base_addr;
8193 1.1 skrll
8194 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz < 728)
8195 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8196 1.1 skrll
8197 1.1 skrll if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
8198 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8199 1.1 skrll
8200 1.1 skrll type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
8201 1.1 skrll
8202 1.1 skrll switch (type)
8203 1.1 skrll {
8204 1.1 skrll case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
8205 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: need to add ->core_command. */
8206 1.1 skrll /* process_info.pid */
8207 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8208 1.1 skrll /* process_info.signal */
8209 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
8210 1.1 skrll break;
8211 1.1 skrll
8212 1.1 skrll case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
8213 1.3 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8214 1.1 skrll /* thread_info.tid */
8215 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
8216 1.1 skrll
8217 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8218 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8219 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8220 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8221 1.1 skrll
8222 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
8223 1.1 skrll
8224 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8225 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8226 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8227 1.1 skrll
8228 1.1 skrll /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8229 1.1 skrll sect->size = 716;
8230 1.1 skrll /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8231 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
8232 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8233 1.1 skrll
8234 1.1 skrll /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
8235 1.1 skrll is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8236 1.1 skrll
8237 1.1 skrll if (is_active_thread)
8238 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8239 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8240 1.1 skrll break;
8241 1.1 skrll
8242 1.1 skrll case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
8243 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
8244 1.3 christos /* module_info.base_address */
8245 1.1 skrll base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
8246 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
8247 1.1 skrll
8248 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8249 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8250 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8251 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8252 1.1 skrll
8253 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
8254 1.1 skrll
8255 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8256 1.1 skrll
8257 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8258 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8259 1.1 skrll
8260 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
8261 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8262 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8263 1.1 skrll break;
8264 1.1 skrll
8265 1.1 skrll default:
8266 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8267 1.1 skrll }
8268 1.1 skrll
8269 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8270 1.1 skrll }
8271 1.1 skrll
8272 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8273 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8274 1.1 skrll {
8275 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8276 1.1 skrll
8277 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
8278 1.1 skrll {
8279 1.1 skrll default:
8280 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8281 1.1 skrll
8282 1.1 skrll case NT_PRSTATUS:
8283 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
8284 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
8285 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8286 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8287 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
8288 1.1 skrll #else
8289 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8290 1.1 skrll #endif
8291 1.1 skrll
8292 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8293 1.1 skrll case NT_PSTATUS:
8294 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
8295 1.1 skrll #endif
8296 1.1 skrll
8297 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8298 1.1 skrll case NT_LWPSTATUS:
8299 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
8300 1.1 skrll #endif
8301 1.1 skrll
8302 1.1 skrll case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
8303 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
8304 1.1 skrll
8305 1.1 skrll case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
8306 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
8307 1.1 skrll
8308 1.1 skrll case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
8309 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
8310 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8311 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
8312 1.3 christos else
8313 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8314 1.3 christos
8315 1.3 christos case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
8316 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8317 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8318 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
8319 1.1 skrll else
8320 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8321 1.1 skrll
8322 1.1 skrll case NT_PPC_VMX:
8323 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
8324 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8325 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
8326 1.1 skrll else
8327 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8328 1.1 skrll
8329 1.1 skrll case NT_PPC_VSX:
8330 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
8331 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8332 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
8333 1.3 christos else
8334 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8335 1.3 christos
8336 1.3 christos case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
8337 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8338 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8339 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
8340 1.3 christos else
8341 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8342 1.3 christos
8343 1.3 christos case NT_S390_TIMER:
8344 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8345 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8346 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
8347 1.3 christos else
8348 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8349 1.3 christos
8350 1.3 christos case NT_S390_TODCMP:
8351 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8352 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8353 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
8354 1.3 christos else
8355 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8356 1.3 christos
8357 1.3 christos case NT_S390_TODPREG:
8358 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8359 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8360 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
8361 1.3 christos else
8362 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8363 1.3 christos
8364 1.3 christos case NT_S390_CTRS:
8365 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8366 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8367 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
8368 1.3 christos else
8369 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8370 1.3 christos
8371 1.3 christos case NT_S390_PREFIX:
8372 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
8373 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8374 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
8375 1.1 skrll else
8376 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8377 1.1 skrll
8378 1.1 skrll case NT_PRPSINFO:
8379 1.1 skrll case NT_PSINFO:
8380 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
8381 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
8382 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8383 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8384 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
8385 1.1 skrll #else
8386 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8387 1.1 skrll #endif
8388 1.1 skrll
8389 1.1 skrll case NT_AUXV:
8390 1.1 skrll {
8391 1.1 skrll asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
8392 1.1 skrll SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8393 1.1 skrll
8394 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8395 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8396 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
8397 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8398 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8399 1.1 skrll
8400 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8401 1.1 skrll }
8402 1.1 skrll }
8403 1.1 skrll }
8404 1.3 christos
8405 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8406 1.1 skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8407 1.1 skrll {
8408 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id_size = note->descsz;
8409 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, note->descsz);
8410 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id == NULL)
8411 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8412 1.1 skrll
8413 1.1 skrll memcpy (elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id, note->descdata, note->descsz);
8414 1.1 skrll
8415 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8416 1.1 skrll }
8417 1.1 skrll
8418 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8419 1.1 skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8420 1.1 skrll {
8421 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
8422 1.1 skrll {
8423 1.1 skrll default:
8424 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8425 1.1 skrll
8426 1.1 skrll case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
8427 1.1 skrll return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
8428 1.1 skrll }
8429 1.1 skrll }
8430 1.1 skrll
8431 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8432 1.1 skrll elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
8433 1.1 skrll {
8434 1.1 skrll char *cp;
8435 1.1 skrll
8436 1.1 skrll cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
8437 1.1 skrll if (cp != NULL)
8438 1.1 skrll {
8439 1.1 skrll *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
8440 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8441 1.1 skrll }
8442 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8443 1.1 skrll }
8444 1.1 skrll
8445 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8446 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8447 1.1 skrll {
8448 1.1 skrll /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8449 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
8450 1.1 skrll = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8451 1.1 skrll
8452 1.1 skrll /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
8453 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
8454 1.1 skrll = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
8455 1.1 skrll
8456 1.1 skrll /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8457 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8458 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
8459 1.1 skrll
8460 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
8461 1.1 skrll note);
8462 1.1 skrll }
8463 1.1 skrll
8464 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8465 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8466 1.1 skrll {
8467 1.1 skrll int lwp;
8468 1.1 skrll
8469 1.1 skrll if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
8470 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwp;
8471 1.1 skrll
8472 1.1 skrll if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
8473 1.1 skrll {
8474 1.1 skrll /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
8475 1.1 skrll find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
8476 1.1 skrll since the kernel writes this note out first when it
8477 1.1 skrll creates a core file. */
8478 1.1 skrll
8479 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8480 1.1 skrll }
8481 1.1 skrll
8482 1.1 skrll /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
8483 1.1 skrll defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
8484 1.1 skrll than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
8485 1.1 skrll understand it. */
8486 1.1 skrll
8487 1.1 skrll if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
8488 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8489 1.1 skrll
8490 1.1 skrll
8491 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
8492 1.1 skrll {
8493 1.1 skrll /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
8494 1.1 skrll PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
8495 1.1 skrll
8496 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_alpha:
8497 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_sparc:
8498 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
8499 1.1 skrll {
8500 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
8501 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8502 1.1 skrll
8503 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
8504 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8505 1.1 skrll
8506 1.1 skrll default:
8507 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8508 1.1 skrll }
8509 1.1 skrll
8510 1.1 skrll /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
8511 1.1 skrll PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
8512 1.1 skrll
8513 1.1 skrll default:
8514 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
8515 1.1 skrll {
8516 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
8517 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8518 1.1 skrll
8519 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
8520 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8521 1.1 skrll
8522 1.1 skrll default:
8523 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8524 1.1 skrll }
8525 1.3 christos }
8526 1.3 christos /* NOTREACHED */
8527 1.3 christos }
8528 1.3 christos
8529 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8530 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8531 1.3 christos {
8532 1.3 christos /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8533 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
8534 1.3 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8535 1.3 christos
8536 1.3 christos /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
8537 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
8538 1.3 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
8539 1.3 christos
8540 1.3 christos /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8541 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8542 1.3 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
8543 1.3 christos
8544 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8545 1.3 christos }
8546 1.3 christos
8547 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8548 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8549 1.3 christos {
8550 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
8551 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8552 1.3 christos
8553 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
8554 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8555 1.3 christos
8556 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
8557 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8558 1.3 christos
8559 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
8560 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
8561 1.3 christos
8562 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
8563 1.3 christos {
8564 1.3 christos asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
8565 1.3 christos SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8566 1.3 christos
8567 1.3 christos if (sect == NULL)
8568 1.3 christos return FALSE;
8569 1.3 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
8570 1.3 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8571 1.3 christos sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8572 1.3 christos
8573 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8574 1.3 christos }
8575 1.3 christos
8576 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
8577 1.3 christos {
8578 1.3 christos asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
8579 1.3 christos SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8580 1.3 christos
8581 1.3 christos if (sect == NULL)
8582 1.3 christos return FALSE;
8583 1.3 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
8584 1.3 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8585 1.3 christos sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8586 1.3 christos
8587 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8588 1.3 christos }
8589 1.1 skrll
8590 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8591 1.1 skrll }
8592 1.1 skrll
8593 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8594 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
8595 1.1 skrll {
8596 1.1 skrll void *ddata = note->descdata;
8597 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
8598 1.1 skrll char *name;
8599 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
8600 1.1 skrll short sig;
8601 1.1 skrll unsigned flags;
8602 1.1 skrll
8603 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
8604 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
8605 1.1 skrll
8606 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
8607 1.1 skrll *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
8608 1.1 skrll
8609 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
8610 1.1 skrll flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
8611 1.1 skrll
8612 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
8613 1.1 skrll if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
8614 1.1 skrll {
8615 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = sig;
8616 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
8617 1.1 skrll }
8618 1.1 skrll
8619 1.1 skrll /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
8620 1.1 skrll do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
8621 1.1 skrll thread just in case. */
8622 1.1 skrll if (flags & 0x00000080)
8623 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
8624 1.1 skrll
8625 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
8626 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
8627 1.1 skrll
8628 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8629 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8630 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8631 1.1 skrll strcpy (name, buf);
8632 1.1 skrll
8633 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8634 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8635 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8636 1.1 skrll
8637 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
8638 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8639 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8640 1.1 skrll
8641 1.1 skrll return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
8642 1.1 skrll }
8643 1.1 skrll
8644 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8645 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
8646 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note *note,
8647 1.1 skrll long tid,
8648 1.1 skrll char *base)
8649 1.1 skrll {
8650 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
8651 1.1 skrll char *name;
8652 1.3 christos asection *sect;
8653 1.1 skrll
8654 1.1 skrll /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
8655 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
8656 1.1 skrll
8657 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8658 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8659 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8660 1.1 skrll strcpy (name, buf);
8661 1.1 skrll
8662 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8663 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8664 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8665 1.1 skrll
8666 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
8667 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8668 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8669 1.1 skrll
8670 1.1 skrll /* This is the current thread. */
8671 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid == tid)
8672 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
8673 1.1 skrll
8674 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8675 1.1 skrll }
8676 1.1 skrll
8677 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
8678 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
8679 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
8680 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
8681 1.1 skrll
8682 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8683 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8684 1.1 skrll {
8685 1.1 skrll /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
8686 1.1 skrll tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
8687 1.1 skrll function. */
8688 1.1 skrll static long tid = 1;
8689 1.1 skrll
8690 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
8691 1.1 skrll {
8692 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
8693 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
8694 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
8695 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
8696 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
8697 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
8698 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
8699 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
8700 1.1 skrll default:
8701 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8702 1.1 skrll }
8703 1.1 skrll }
8704 1.1 skrll
8705 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8706 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8707 1.1 skrll {
8708 1.1 skrll char *name;
8709 1.3 christos asection *sect;
8710 1.1 skrll size_t len;
8711 1.1 skrll
8712 1.1 skrll /* Use note name as section name. */
8713 1.1 skrll len = note->namesz;
8714 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8715 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8716 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8717 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
8718 1.1 skrll name[len - 1] = '\0';
8719 1.1 skrll
8720 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8721 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8722 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8723 1.1 skrll
8724 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
8725 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8726 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 1;
8727 1.1 skrll
8728 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8729 1.1 skrll }
8730 1.1 skrll
8731 1.1 skrll /* Function: elfcore_write_note
8732 1.1 skrll
8733 1.1 skrll Inputs:
8734 1.1 skrll buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
8735 1.1 skrll name of note
8736 1.1 skrll type of note
8737 1.1 skrll data for note
8738 1.1 skrll size of data for note
8739 1.1 skrll
8740 1.1 skrll Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
8741 1.1 skrll for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
8742 1.1 skrll that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
8743 1.1 skrll 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
8744 1.1 skrll
8745 1.1 skrll Return:
8746 1.1 skrll Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
8747 1.1 skrll
8748 1.1 skrll char *
8749 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
8750 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8751 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8752 1.1 skrll const char *name,
8753 1.1 skrll int type,
8754 1.1 skrll const void *input,
8755 1.1 skrll int size)
8756 1.1 skrll {
8757 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Note *xnp;
8758 1.1 skrll size_t namesz;
8759 1.1 skrll size_t newspace;
8760 1.1 skrll char *dest;
8761 1.1 skrll
8762 1.1 skrll namesz = 0;
8763 1.3 christos if (name != NULL)
8764 1.1 skrll namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
8765 1.1 skrll
8766 1.1 skrll newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
8767 1.1 skrll
8768 1.1 skrll buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
8769 1.1 skrll if (buf == NULL)
8770 1.1 skrll return buf;
8771 1.1 skrll dest = buf + *bufsiz;
8772 1.1 skrll *bufsiz += newspace;
8773 1.1 skrll xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
8774 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
8775 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
8776 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
8777 1.1 skrll dest = xnp->name;
8778 1.1 skrll if (name != NULL)
8779 1.1 skrll {
8780 1.1 skrll memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
8781 1.1 skrll dest += namesz;
8782 1.1 skrll while (namesz & 3)
8783 1.1 skrll {
8784 1.1 skrll *dest++ = '\0';
8785 1.1 skrll ++namesz;
8786 1.1 skrll }
8787 1.1 skrll }
8788 1.1 skrll memcpy (dest, input, size);
8789 1.1 skrll dest += size;
8790 1.1 skrll while (size & 3)
8791 1.1 skrll {
8792 1.1 skrll *dest++ = '\0';
8793 1.1 skrll ++size;
8794 1.1 skrll }
8795 1.1 skrll return buf;
8796 1.1 skrll }
8797 1.1 skrll
8798 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8799 1.1 skrll char *
8800 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
8801 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8802 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8803 1.1 skrll const char *fname,
8804 1.1 skrll const char *psargs)
8805 1.1 skrll {
8806 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
8807 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8808 1.1 skrll
8809 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
8810 1.1 skrll {
8811 1.1 skrll char *ret;
8812 1.1 skrll ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8813 1.1 skrll NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
8814 1.1 skrll if (ret != NULL)
8815 1.1 skrll return ret;
8816 1.1 skrll }
8817 1.1 skrll
8818 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8819 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8820 1.1 skrll {
8821 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8822 1.1 skrll psinfo32_t data;
8823 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
8824 1.1 skrll #else
8825 1.1 skrll prpsinfo32_t data;
8826 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
8827 1.1 skrll #endif
8828 1.1 skrll
8829 1.1 skrll memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
8830 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
8831 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
8832 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8833 1.1 skrll note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
8834 1.1 skrll }
8835 1.1 skrll else
8836 1.1 skrll #endif
8837 1.1 skrll {
8838 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8839 1.1 skrll psinfo_t data;
8840 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
8841 1.1 skrll #else
8842 1.1 skrll prpsinfo_t data;
8843 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
8844 1.1 skrll #endif
8845 1.1 skrll
8846 1.1 skrll memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
8847 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
8848 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
8849 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8850 1.1 skrll note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
8851 1.1 skrll }
8852 1.1 skrll }
8853 1.1 skrll #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
8854 1.1 skrll
8855 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8856 1.1 skrll char *
8857 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
8858 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8859 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8860 1.1 skrll long pid,
8861 1.1 skrll int cursig,
8862 1.1 skrll const void *gregs)
8863 1.1 skrll {
8864 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
8865 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8866 1.1 skrll
8867 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
8868 1.1 skrll {
8869 1.1 skrll char *ret;
8870 1.1 skrll ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8871 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS,
8872 1.1 skrll pid, cursig, gregs);
8873 1.1 skrll if (ret != NULL)
8874 1.1 skrll return ret;
8875 1.1 skrll }
8876 1.1 skrll
8877 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
8878 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8879 1.1 skrll {
8880 1.1 skrll prstatus32_t prstat;
8881 1.1 skrll
8882 1.1 skrll memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
8883 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_pid = pid;
8884 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8885 1.1 skrll memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
8886 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8887 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
8888 1.1 skrll }
8889 1.1 skrll else
8890 1.1 skrll #endif
8891 1.1 skrll {
8892 1.1 skrll prstatus_t prstat;
8893 1.1 skrll
8894 1.1 skrll memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
8895 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_pid = pid;
8896 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8897 1.1 skrll memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
8898 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8899 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
8900 1.1 skrll }
8901 1.1 skrll }
8902 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
8903 1.1 skrll
8904 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8905 1.1 skrll char *
8906 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
8907 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8908 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8909 1.1 skrll long pid,
8910 1.1 skrll int cursig,
8911 1.1 skrll const void *gregs)
8912 1.1 skrll {
8913 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8914 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
8915 1.1 skrll
8916 1.1 skrll memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
8917 1.1 skrll lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
8918 1.1 skrll lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8919 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8920 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
8921 1.1 skrll #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8922 1.1 skrll #if !defined(gregs)
8923 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
8924 1.1 skrll gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
8925 1.1 skrll #else
8926 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
8927 1.1 skrll gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
8928 1.1 skrll #endif
8929 1.1 skrll #endif
8930 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8931 1.1 skrll NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
8932 1.1 skrll }
8933 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
8934 1.1 skrll
8935 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8936 1.1 skrll char *
8937 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
8938 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8939 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8940 1.1 skrll long pid,
8941 1.1 skrll int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8942 1.1 skrll const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8943 1.1 skrll {
8944 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
8945 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8946 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8947 1.1 skrll
8948 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8949 1.1 skrll {
8950 1.1 skrll pstatus32_t pstat;
8951 1.1 skrll
8952 1.1 skrll memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
8953 1.1 skrll pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
8954 1.1 skrll buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8955 1.1 skrll NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
8956 1.1 skrll return buf;
8957 1.1 skrll }
8958 1.1 skrll else
8959 1.1 skrll #endif
8960 1.1 skrll {
8961 1.1 skrll pstatus_t pstat;
8962 1.1 skrll
8963 1.1 skrll memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
8964 1.1 skrll pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
8965 1.1 skrll buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8966 1.1 skrll NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
8967 1.1 skrll return buf;
8968 1.1 skrll }
8969 1.1 skrll }
8970 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
8971 1.1 skrll
8972 1.1 skrll char *
8973 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
8974 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8975 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8976 1.1 skrll const void *fpregs,
8977 1.1 skrll int size)
8978 1.1 skrll {
8979 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
8980 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8981 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
8982 1.1 skrll }
8983 1.1 skrll
8984 1.1 skrll char *
8985 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
8986 1.1 skrll char *buf,
8987 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
8988 1.1 skrll const void *xfpregs,
8989 1.1 skrll int size)
8990 1.1 skrll {
8991 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
8992 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8993 1.3 christos note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
8994 1.3 christos }
8995 1.3 christos
8996 1.3 christos char *
8997 1.3 christos elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
8998 1.3 christos const void *xfpregs, int size)
8999 1.3 christos {
9000 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9001 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9002 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
9003 1.1 skrll }
9004 1.1 skrll
9005 1.1 skrll char *
9006 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
9007 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9008 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9009 1.1 skrll const void *ppc_vmx,
9010 1.1 skrll int size)
9011 1.1 skrll {
9012 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
9013 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9014 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
9015 1.1 skrll }
9016 1.1 skrll
9017 1.1 skrll char *
9018 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
9019 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9020 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9021 1.1 skrll const void *ppc_vsx,
9022 1.1 skrll int size)
9023 1.1 skrll {
9024 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9025 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9026 1.3 christos note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
9027 1.3 christos }
9028 1.3 christos
9029 1.3 christos static char *
9030 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
9031 1.3 christos char *buf,
9032 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
9033 1.3 christos const void *s390_high_gprs,
9034 1.3 christos int size)
9035 1.3 christos {
9036 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9037 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9038 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
9039 1.3 christos s390_high_gprs, size);
9040 1.3 christos }
9041 1.3 christos
9042 1.3 christos char *
9043 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
9044 1.3 christos char *buf,
9045 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
9046 1.3 christos const void *s390_timer,
9047 1.3 christos int size)
9048 1.3 christos {
9049 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9050 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9051 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
9052 1.3 christos }
9053 1.3 christos
9054 1.3 christos char *
9055 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
9056 1.3 christos char *buf,
9057 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
9058 1.3 christos const void *s390_todcmp,
9059 1.3 christos int size)
9060 1.3 christos {
9061 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9062 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9063 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
9064 1.3 christos }
9065 1.3 christos
9066 1.3 christos char *
9067 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
9068 1.3 christos char *buf,
9069 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
9070 1.3 christos const void *s390_todpreg,
9071 1.3 christos int size)
9072 1.3 christos {
9073 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9074 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9075 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
9076 1.3 christos }
9077 1.3 christos
9078 1.3 christos char *
9079 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
9080 1.3 christos char *buf,
9081 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
9082 1.3 christos const void *s390_ctrs,
9083 1.3 christos int size)
9084 1.3 christos {
9085 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
9086 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9087 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
9088 1.3 christos }
9089 1.3 christos
9090 1.3 christos char *
9091 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
9092 1.3 christos char *buf,
9093 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
9094 1.3 christos const void *s390_prefix,
9095 1.3 christos int size)
9096 1.3 christos {
9097 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
9098 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9099 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
9100 1.1 skrll }
9101 1.1 skrll
9102 1.1 skrll char *
9103 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
9104 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9105 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9106 1.1 skrll const char *section,
9107 1.1 skrll const void *data,
9108 1.1 skrll int size)
9109 1.3 christos {
9110 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
9111 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9112 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
9113 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9114 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
9115 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9116 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
9117 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9118 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
9119 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9120 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
9121 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9122 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
9123 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9124 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
9125 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9126 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
9127 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9128 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
9129 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9130 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
9131 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9132 1.1 skrll return NULL;
9133 1.1 skrll }
9134 1.1 skrll
9135 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9136 1.1 skrll elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
9137 1.1 skrll {
9138 1.1 skrll char *p;
9139 1.1 skrll
9140 1.1 skrll p = buf;
9141 1.1 skrll while (p < buf + size)
9142 1.1 skrll {
9143 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
9144 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
9145 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note in;
9146 1.1 skrll
9147 1.1 skrll if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
9148 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9149 1.1 skrll
9150 1.1 skrll in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
9151 1.1 skrll
9152 1.1 skrll in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
9153 1.1 skrll in.namedata = xnp->name;
9154 1.1 skrll if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
9155 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9156 1.1 skrll
9157 1.1 skrll in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
9158 1.1 skrll in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
9159 1.1 skrll in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
9160 1.1 skrll if (in.descsz != 0
9161 1.1 skrll && (in.descdata >= buf + size
9162 1.1 skrll || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
9163 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9164 1.1 skrll
9165 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
9166 1.1 skrll {
9167 1.1 skrll default:
9168 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9169 1.1 skrll
9170 1.1 skrll case bfd_core:
9171 1.3 christos if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "NetBSD-CORE"))
9172 1.3 christos {
9173 1.3 christos if (! elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (abfd, &in))
9174 1.3 christos return FALSE;
9175 1.3 christos }
9176 1.1 skrll else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "OpenBSD"))
9177 1.1 skrll {
9178 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (abfd, &in))
9179 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9180 1.1 skrll }
9181 1.1 skrll else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "QNX"))
9182 1.1 skrll {
9183 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_grok_nto_note (abfd, &in))
9184 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9185 1.1 skrll }
9186 1.1 skrll else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "SPU/"))
9187 1.1 skrll {
9188 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_grok_spu_note (abfd, &in))
9189 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9190 1.1 skrll }
9191 1.1 skrll else
9192 1.1 skrll {
9193 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_grok_note (abfd, &in))
9194 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9195 1.1 skrll }
9196 1.1 skrll break;
9197 1.1 skrll
9198 1.1 skrll case bfd_object:
9199 1.1 skrll if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
9200 1.1 skrll {
9201 1.1 skrll if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
9202 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9203 1.1 skrll }
9204 1.1 skrll break;
9205 1.1 skrll }
9206 1.1 skrll
9207 1.1 skrll p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
9208 1.1 skrll }
9209 1.1 skrll
9210 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9211 1.1 skrll }
9212 1.1 skrll
9213 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9214 1.1 skrll elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
9215 1.1 skrll {
9216 1.1 skrll char *buf;
9217 1.1 skrll
9218 1.1 skrll if (size <= 0)
9219 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9220 1.1 skrll
9221 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
9222 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9223 1.1 skrll
9224 1.1 skrll buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size);
9225 1.1 skrll if (buf == NULL)
9226 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9227 1.1 skrll
9228 1.1 skrll if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
9229 1.1 skrll || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
9230 1.1 skrll {
9231 1.1 skrll free (buf);
9232 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9233 1.1 skrll }
9234 1.1 skrll
9235 1.1 skrll free (buf);
9236 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9237 1.1 skrll }
9238 1.1 skrll
9239 1.1 skrll /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
9241 1.1 skrll
9242 1.1 skrll /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
9243 1.1 skrll copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
9244 1.1 skrll occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
9245 1.1 skrll
9246 1.1 skrll long
9247 1.1 skrll bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
9248 1.1 skrll {
9249 1.1 skrll if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9250 1.1 skrll {
9251 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
9252 1.1 skrll return -1;
9253 1.1 skrll }
9254 1.1 skrll
9255 1.1 skrll return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
9256 1.1 skrll }
9257 1.1 skrll
9258 1.1 skrll /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
9259 1.1 skrll will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
9260 1.1 skrll defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
9261 1.1 skrll buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
9262 1.1 skrll
9263 1.1 skrll Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
9264 1.1 skrll error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
9265 1.1 skrll
9266 1.1 skrll int
9267 1.1 skrll bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
9268 1.1 skrll {
9269 1.1 skrll int num_phdrs;
9270 1.1 skrll
9271 1.1 skrll if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9272 1.1 skrll {
9273 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
9274 1.1 skrll return -1;
9275 1.1 skrll }
9276 1.1 skrll
9277 1.1 skrll num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
9278 1.1 skrll memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
9279 1.1 skrll num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
9280 1.1 skrll
9281 1.1 skrll return num_phdrs;
9282 1.1 skrll }
9283 1.1 skrll
9284 1.1 skrll enum elf_reloc_type_class
9285 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9286 1.1 skrll {
9287 1.1 skrll return reloc_class_normal;
9288 1.1 skrll }
9289 1.1 skrll
9290 1.1 skrll /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
9291 1.1 skrll relocation against a local symbol. */
9292 1.1 skrll
9293 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
9294 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
9295 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
9296 1.1 skrll asection **psec,
9297 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9298 1.1 skrll {
9299 1.1 skrll asection *sec = *psec;
9300 1.1 skrll bfd_vma relocation;
9301 1.1 skrll
9302 1.1 skrll relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
9303 1.1 skrll + sec->output_offset
9304 1.1 skrll + sym->st_value);
9305 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
9306 1.1 skrll && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
9307 1.1 skrll && sec->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
9308 1.1 skrll {
9309 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend =
9310 1.1 skrll _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
9311 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9312 1.1 skrll sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
9313 1.1 skrll if (sec != *psec)
9314 1.1 skrll {
9315 1.1 skrll /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
9316 1.1 skrll marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
9317 1.1 skrll SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
9318 1.1 skrll other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
9319 1.1 skrll some info around for --emit-relocs. */
9320 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
9321 1.1 skrll sec->kept_section = *psec;
9322 1.1 skrll sec = *psec;
9323 1.1 skrll }
9324 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend -= relocation;
9325 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9326 1.1 skrll }
9327 1.1 skrll return relocation;
9328 1.1 skrll }
9329 1.1 skrll
9330 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
9331 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
9332 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
9333 1.1 skrll asection **psec,
9334 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addend)
9335 1.1 skrll {
9336 1.1 skrll asection *sec = *psec;
9337 1.1 skrll
9338 1.1 skrll if (sec->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
9339 1.1 skrll return sym->st_value + addend;
9340 1.1 skrll
9341 1.1 skrll return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
9342 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9343 1.1 skrll sym->st_value + addend);
9344 1.1 skrll }
9345 1.1 skrll
9346 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
9347 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
9348 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *info,
9349 1.1 skrll asection *sec,
9350 1.1 skrll bfd_vma offset)
9351 1.1 skrll {
9352 1.1 skrll switch (sec->sec_info_type)
9353 1.1 skrll {
9354 1.1 skrll case ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
9355 1.1 skrll return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9356 1.1 skrll offset);
9357 1.1 skrll case ELF_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
9358 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
9359 1.1 skrll default:
9360 1.1 skrll return offset;
9361 1.1 skrll }
9362 1.1 skrll }
9363 1.1 skrll
9364 1.1 skrll /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
9366 1.1 skrll reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
9367 1.1 skrll based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
9368 1.1 skrll points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
9369 1.1 skrll between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
9370 1.1 skrll file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
9371 1.1 skrll
9372 1.1 skrll The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
9373 1.1 skrll remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
9374 1.1 skrll should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
9375 1.1 skrll be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
9376 1.1 skrll the remote memory. */
9377 1.1 skrll
9378 1.1 skrll bfd *
9379 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
9380 1.1 skrll (bfd *templ,
9381 1.1 skrll bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
9382 1.1 skrll bfd_vma *loadbasep,
9383 1.1 skrll int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, int))
9384 1.1 skrll {
9385 1.1 skrll return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
9386 1.1 skrll (templ, ehdr_vma, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
9387 1.1 skrll }
9388 1.1 skrll
9389 1.1 skrll long
9391 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
9392 1.1 skrll long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9393 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9394 1.1 skrll long dynsymcount,
9395 1.1 skrll asymbol **dynsyms,
9396 1.1 skrll asymbol **ret)
9397 1.1 skrll {
9398 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9399 1.1 skrll asection *relplt;
9400 1.1 skrll asymbol *s;
9401 1.1 skrll const char *relplt_name;
9402 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
9403 1.1 skrll arelent *p;
9404 1.1 skrll long count, i, n;
9405 1.1 skrll size_t size;
9406 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9407 1.1 skrll char *names;
9408 1.1 skrll asection *plt;
9409 1.1 skrll
9410 1.1 skrll *ret = NULL;
9411 1.1 skrll
9412 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
9413 1.1 skrll return 0;
9414 1.1 skrll
9415 1.1 skrll if (dynsymcount <= 0)
9416 1.1 skrll return 0;
9417 1.1 skrll
9418 1.1 skrll if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
9419 1.1 skrll return 0;
9420 1.1 skrll
9421 1.1 skrll relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
9422 1.1 skrll if (relplt_name == NULL)
9423 1.1 skrll relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
9424 1.1 skrll relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
9425 1.1 skrll if (relplt == NULL)
9426 1.1 skrll return 0;
9427 1.1 skrll
9428 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
9429 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
9430 1.1 skrll || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
9431 1.1 skrll return 0;
9432 1.1 skrll
9433 1.1 skrll plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
9434 1.1 skrll if (plt == NULL)
9435 1.1 skrll return 0;
9436 1.1 skrll
9437 1.3 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
9438 1.3 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
9439 1.3 christos return -1;
9440 1.3 christos
9441 1.3 christos count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
9442 1.3 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
9443 1.3 christos p = relplt->relocation;
9444 1.3 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
9445 1.3 christos {
9446 1.3 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
9447 1.3 christos if (p->addend != 0)
9448 1.1 skrll {
9449 1.3 christos #ifdef BFD64
9450 1.1 skrll size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
9451 1.1 skrll #else
9452 1.1 skrll size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
9453 1.1 skrll #endif
9454 1.1 skrll }
9455 1.1 skrll }
9456 1.1 skrll
9457 1.1 skrll s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
9458 1.1 skrll if (s == NULL)
9459 1.1 skrll return -1;
9460 1.1 skrll
9461 1.1 skrll names = (char *) (s + count);
9462 1.1 skrll p = relplt->relocation;
9463 1.1 skrll n = 0;
9464 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
9465 1.1 skrll {
9466 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9467 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addr;
9468 1.1 skrll
9469 1.1 skrll addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
9470 1.1 skrll if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
9471 1.1 skrll continue;
9472 1.1 skrll
9473 1.1 skrll *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
9474 1.1 skrll /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
9475 1.1 skrll we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
9476 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
9477 1.1 skrll s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
9478 1.3 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
9479 1.3 christos s->section = plt;
9480 1.3 christos s->value = addr - plt->vma;
9481 1.3 christos s->name = names;
9482 1.3 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
9483 1.3 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
9484 1.3 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
9485 1.3 christos names += len;
9486 1.3 christos if (p->addend != 0)
9487 1.3 christos {
9488 1.3 christos char buf[30], *a;
9489 1.3 christos
9490 1.3 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
9491 1.1 skrll names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
9492 1.1 skrll bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
9493 1.1 skrll for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
9494 1.1 skrll ;
9495 1.1 skrll len = strlen (a);
9496 1.1 skrll memcpy (names, a, len);
9497 1.1 skrll names += len;
9498 1.1 skrll }
9499 1.1 skrll memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
9500 1.1 skrll names += sizeof ("@plt");
9501 1.1 skrll ++s, ++n;
9502 1.1 skrll }
9503 1.1 skrll
9504 1.1 skrll return n;
9505 1.1 skrll }
9506 1.1 skrll
9507 1.1 skrll /* It is only used by x86-64 so far. */
9508 1.1 skrll asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
9509 1.1 skrll = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
9510 1.1 skrll SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
9511 1.1 skrll
9512 1.1 skrll void
9513 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_set_osabi (bfd * abfd,
9514 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9515 1.3 christos {
9516 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
9517 1.3 christos
9518 1.3 christos i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
9519 1.3 christos
9520 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
9521 1.1 skrll
9522 1.1 skrll /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
9523 1.1 skrll osabi field to ELFOSABI_LINUX if the binary contains symbols of
9524 1.1 skrll the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
9525 1.3 christos if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
9526 1.1 skrll && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
9527 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_LINUX;
9528 1.1 skrll }
9529 1.1 skrll
9530 1.3 christos
9531 1.3 christos /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
9532 1.1 skrll This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
9533 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
9534
9535 bfd_boolean
9536 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
9537 {
9538 return (type == STT_FUNC
9539 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
9540 }
9541